Pentax Digital Camera 12050 User Manual

SLR Digital Camera  
Operating Manual  
For optimum camera performance, please read the  
Operating Manual before using the camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Thank you for purchasing this PENTAX I/J Digital Camera. Please  
read this manual before using the camera in order to get the most out of all the features  
and functions. Keep this manual safe, as it can be a valuable tool in helping you to  
understand all the camera’s capabilities.  
Lenses you can use  
In general, lenses that can be used with this camera are DA, DA L, D FA and FA J  
lenses and lenses that have an s position on the aperture ring. To use any other lens  
or accessory, see p.56 and p.297.  
Regarding copyrights  
Images taken with the I/J that are for anything other than personal  
enjoyment cannot be used without permission according to the rights as specified in the  
Copyright Act. Please take care, as there are cases where limitations are placed on  
taking pictures even for personal enjoyment during demonstrations, performances or of  
items on display. Images taken with the purpose of obtaining copyrights also cannot be  
used outside the scope of use of the copyright as laid out in the Copyright Act, and care  
should be taken here also.  
Regarding trademarks  
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the  
United States and other countries. Windows Vista is either a registered trademark or  
trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.  
Macintosh and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other  
countries.  
Intel, Intel Core, and Pentium are trademarks of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and other  
countries.  
SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.  
This product includes DNG technology under license by Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
The DNG logo is either a registered trademark or trademark of Adobe Systems  
Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or  
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
All other brands or product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their  
respective companies.  
This product supports PRINT Image Matching III. PRINT Image Matching enabled  
digital still cameras, printers and software help photographers to produce images more  
faithful to their intentions. Some functions are not available on printers that are not  
PRINT Image Matching III compliant.  
Copyright 2001 Seiko Epson Corporation. All Rights Reserved.  
PRINT Image Matching is a trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation.  
The PRINT Image Matching logo is a trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
To users of this camera  
Do not use or store this camera in the vicinity of equipment that generates strong  
electromagnetic radiation or magnetic fields. Strong static charges or the magnetic fields  
produced by equipment such as radio transmitters could interfere with the monitor, damage  
the stored data, or affect the camera’s internal circuitry and cause camera misoperation.  
• The liquid crystal panel used for the monitor is manufactured using extremely high  
precision technology. Although the level of functioning pixels is 99.99% or better, you  
should be aware that 0.01% or fewer of the pixels may not illuminate or may illuminate  
when they should not. However, this has no effect on the recorded image.  
• There is a possibility that the illustrations and the display screen of the monitor in this  
manual are different from the actual ones.  
• In this manual, SD Memory Cards, SDHC Memory Cards and SDXC Memory Cards  
are referred to as SD Memory Cards.  
• In this manual, the generic term “computer(s)” refers to either a Windows PC or a  
Macintosh hereafter.  
• In this manual, the term “battery(ies)” refers to any type of batteries used for this  
camera and its accessories.  
• The I and J can essentially be used in the same manner. In this  
manual, the explanations and examples are mainly for using the I.  
J users should refer to “About the J” (p.18).  
For Using Your Camera Safely  
We have paid close attention to the safety of this camera. When using this camera,  
we request your special attention regarding items marked with the following symbols.  
This symbol indicates that ignoring this item could cause  
serious personal injuries.  
Warning  
This symbol indicates that ignoring this item could cause minor  
Caution  
or medium personal injuries, or loss of property.  
About the Camera  
Warning  
• Do not disassemble or modify the camera. High voltage areas are present  
inside the camera, with the risk of electric shock.  
• If the camera interior is exposed due to dropping or otherwise damaging the  
camera, never touch the exposed portion. There is a risk of electric shock.  
• Do not aim the camera at the sun or other strong light sources when taking  
pictures or leave the camera sitting in direct sunlight with the lens cap off.  
Doing so may cause the camera to malfunction or cause a fire.  
• Do not look at the sun or other strong light sources through the lens. Doing  
so may lead to a loss of eyesight or cause vision to be impaired.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2
• If any irregularities occur during use, such as smoke or a strange odor, stop  
use immediately, remove the battery or the AC adapter, and contact your  
nearest PENTAX Service Center. Continued use can cause a fire or  
electrical shock.  
Caution  
• Do not place your finger over the flash when discharging the flash. You may  
burn yourself.  
• Do not cover the flash with clothing when discharging the flash. Discoloration  
may occur.  
• Some portions of the camera heat up during use. There is a risk of low  
temperature burns when holding such portions for long periods.  
• Should the monitor be damaged, be careful of glass fragments. Also, be  
careful not to allow the liquid crystal to get on your skin or in your eyes or  
mouth.  
• Depending on your individual factors or physical condition, the use of the  
camera may cause itching, rashes or blisters. In case of any abnormality,  
stop using the camera and get medical attention immediately.  
About the Battery Charger and AC Adapter  
Warning  
Always use the battery charger and AC adapter exclusively developed for this  
camera, with the specified power and voltage. Using a battery charger or AC  
adapter not exclusive to this camera, or using the exclusive battery charger  
or AC adapter with an unspecified power or voltage can cause a fire, electric  
shock, or camera breakdown. The specified voltage is 100 - 240V AC.  
• Do not disassemble or modify the product. This can cause a fire or electrical  
shock.  
If the generation of smoke or strange odor from the product or other abnormality  
occurs, immediately discontinue using and consult a PENTAX Service Center.  
Continued use can cause a fire or electrical shock.  
• If water should happen to get inside the product, consult a PENTAX Service  
Center. Continued use can cause a fire or electrical shock.  
• If you see a lightning flash or hear thunder during use of the battery charger  
or AC adapter, unplug the power plug and discontinue use. Continued use  
can cause damage to the product, fire or electrical shock.  
• Wipe off the power plug if it should become covered with dust. Accumulated  
dust may cause a fire.  
• To reduce the risk of hazards, use only CSA/UL certified power supply cord  
set, cord is Type SPT-2 or heavier, minimum NO.18 AWG copper, one end  
with a molded-on male attachment plug cap (with a specified NEMA  
configuration), and the other is provided with a molded-on female connector  
body (with a specified IEC nonindustrial type configuration) or the equivalent.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
Caution  
• Do not place or drop heavy objects on or forcefully bend the AC plug cord.  
Doing so may damage the cord. Should the AC plug cord be damaged,  
consult a PENTAX Service Center.  
• Do not touch or short-circuit the terminal area of the AC plug cord while the  
cord is plugged in.  
• Do not handle the power plug with wet hands. This can cause an electric  
shock.  
• Do not drop the product, or subject it to violent impact. This can cause the  
product to breakdown.  
Do not use the battery charger D-BC90 to charge batteries other than the  
rechargeable lithium-ion battery D-LI90. Attempting to charge other types of  
batteries may cause an explosion or heating, or may damage the battery  
charger.  
About the Battery  
Warning  
• If any leakage from the battery should come in contact with your eyes, do not  
rub them. Flush your eyes with clean water and get medical attention  
immediately.  
Caution  
• Only use the specified battery with this camera. Use of other batteries may  
cause an explosion or fire.  
• Do not disassemble the battery. Disassembling the battery may cause an  
explosion or leakage.  
• Remove the battery from the camera immediately if it becomes hot or begins  
to smoke. Be careful not to burn yourself during removal.  
• Keep wires, hairpins, and other metal objects away from the + and - contacts  
of the battery.  
• Do not short the battery or dispose of the battery in fire. This can cause an  
explosion or fire.  
• If any leakage from the battery should come in contact with skin or clothing,  
it may cause irritation to the skin. Wash the affected areas thoroughly with  
water.  
• Precautions for D-LI90 Battery Usage:  
USE SPECIFIED CHARGER ONLY.  
- RISK OF FIRE AND BURNS.  
- DO NOT INCINERATE.  
- DO NOT DISASSEMBLE.  
- DO NOT SHORT CIRCUIT.  
- DO NOT EXPOSE TO HIGH TEMP. (140°F / 60°C)  
- SEE MANUAL.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Keep the Camera and its Accessories out of  
the Reach of Small Children  
Warning  
Do not place the camera and its accessories within the reach of small children.  
1. If the product falls or is operated accidentally, it may cause serious  
personal injuries.  
2. Wrapping the strap around a neck may cause suffocation.  
3. To avoid the risk of a small accessory such as the battery or SD Memory  
Cards from being swallowed by mistake, keep them out of the reach of  
small children. Seek medical attention immediately if an accessory is  
accidentally swallowed.  
Care to be Taken During Handling  
Before Using Your Camera  
• When traveling, take the Worldwide Service Network listing that is included  
in the package. This will be useful if you experience problems abroad.  
• When the camera has not been used for a long time, confirm that it is still  
working properly, particularly prior to taking important pictures (such as at a  
wedding or when traveling). Contents of the recording cannot be guaranteed  
if recording, playback or transferring your data to a computer, etc. is not  
possible due to a malfunction of your camera or recording media (SD  
Memory Card), etc.  
About the Battery and Charger  
• To keep the battery in optimum condition, avoid storing it in a fully charged  
state or in high temperatures.  
• If the battery is left inserted and the camera is not used for a long time, the  
battery will over-discharge and shorten the battery’s life.  
• Charging the battery a day before use or on the day of use is recommended.  
• The AC plug cord provided with this camera is developed exclusively for the  
battery charger D-BC90. Do not use it with other devices.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5
Precautions on Carrying and Using Your Camera  
• Do not subject the camera to high temperatures or high humidity. Do not  
leave the camera in a vehicle, as the temperature can get very high.  
• Do not subject the camera to strong vibrations, shocks, or pressure. Use a  
cushion to protect the camera from vibrations of motorcycles, automobiles,  
or ships.  
• The temperature range for camera use is -10°C to 40°C (14°F to 104°F).  
• The monitor may appear black at high temperatures, but will return to normal  
at normal temperatures.  
• The monitor may respond more slowly at low temperatures. This is due to  
liquid crystal properties, and is not a malfunction.  
• Sudden temperature changes will cause condensation on the inside and  
outside of the camera. Place the camera in your bag or a plastic bag, and  
remove it after temperatures of the camera and surroundings are equalized.  
• Avoid contact with garbage, mud, sand, dust, water, toxic gases, or salt.  
These could cause the camera to breakdown. Wipe the camera to dry off any  
rain or water drops.  
• Do not press the monitor with excessive force. This could cause it to break  
or malfunction.  
Be careful not to overtighten the screw in the tripod socket when using a tripod.  
Cleaning Your Camera  
• Do not clean the camera with organic solvents such as thinner, alcohol, or  
benzine.  
• Use a lens brush to remove dust accumulated on the lens or viewfinder.  
Never use a spray blower for cleaning as it may damage the lens.  
• Please contact a PENTAX Service Center for professional cleaning of the  
CMOS sensor. (This will involve a fee.)  
• Periodic inspections are recommended every one to two years to maintain  
high performance.  
Storing Your Camera  
• Do not store the camera with preservatives or chemicals. Storage in high  
temperatures and high humidity can cause mold to grow on the camera.  
Remove the camera from its case and store it in a dry and well-ventilated  
place.  
• Avoid using or storing the camera where it may be exposed to static  
electricity or electrical interference.  
• Avoid using or storing the camera in direct sunlight or in locations where it  
may be exposed to rapid changes in temperature or to condensation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Other Precautions  
• The SD Memory Card is equipped with a write-  
protect switch. Setting the switch to LOCK  
prevents new data from being recorded on the  
card, the stored data from being deleted, and the  
card from being formatted by the camera or  
computer.  
Write-protect  
switch  
The SD Memory Card may be hot when removing  
the card immediately after using the camera.  
• Do not remove the SD Memory Card or turn off the power while the card is being  
accessed. This may cause the data to be lost or the card to be damaged.  
• Do not bend the SD Memory Card or subject it to violent impact. Keep it away from  
water and store away from high temperatures.  
• Do not remove the SD Memory Card while formatting. The card may be damaged and  
become unusable.  
Data on the SD Memory Card may be deleted in the following circumstances. We do  
not accept any liability for data that is deleted if  
1. the SD Memory Card is mishandled by the user.  
2. the SD Memory Card is exposed to static electricity or electrical interference.  
3. the SD Memory Card has not been used for a long time.  
4. the SD Memory Card or the battery is removed while the card is being accessed.  
• If the SD Memory Card is not used for a long time, the data on the card may become  
unreadable. Be sure to regularly make a backup of important data on a computer.  
• Format new SD Memory Cards. Also format SD Memory Cards previously used with  
other cameras or devices.  
• Please note that deleting data stored on an SD Memory Card, or formatting an SD  
Memory Card does not completely erase the original data. Deleted data can  
sometimes be recovered using commercially available software. If you are going to  
discard, give away or sell your SD Memory Card, you should ensure that the data on  
the card is completely deleted or the card itself is destroyed if it contains any personal  
or sensitive information.  
• The data on your SD Memory Card should be managed at your own risk.  
Regarding Product Registration  
In order to better serve you, we request that you complete the product registration, which  
can be found on the CD-ROM supplied with the camera or on the PENTAX website.  
Refer to p.286 for details. Thank you for your cooperation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8
Checking the Composition, Exposure and Focus Before  
Shooting (Preview) .................................................................... 118  
Using the Shake Reduction Function to Prevent Camera  
Shake .......................................................................................... 122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
Shooting while the Exposure is Automatically Changed (Exposure  
Bracketing)........................................................................................138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Changing the Number of Recorded Pixels and Quality Level  
(Resize) ............................................................................................230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Correcting Defective Pixels in the CMOS Sensor  
(Pixel Mapping) .......................................................................... 273  
Displaying the Distance and Direction to the Destination (Simple  
Navigation)........................................................................................306  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
Composition of the Operating Manual  
This Operating Manual contains the following chapters.  
1
2
Explains camera characteristics, accessories and the names and functions of  
various parts.  
Explains your first steps from purchasing the camera to taking pictures. Be sure to  
read this chapter and follow the instructions.  
3
Explains the procedures for taking and playing back pictures.  
4
Explains the shooting-related functions.  
5
Explains how to use the built-in flash and external flashes.  
6
Explains the procedures for configuring image processing and setting the file  
format.  
7
Explains the procedures for playing back, deleting, and protecting pictures.  
8
Explains the procedures for changing the image size, applying digital filters and  
developing images taken in RAW format.  
9
10  
11  
Explains the procedures for changing the camera settings, such as the monitor  
display settings and the image file naming convention.  
Explains how to connect the camera to a computer, and includes installation  
instructions and a general overview of the provided software.  
Explains troubleshooting and provides various resources.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14  
The symbols used in this Operating Manual are explained below.  
Indicates reference page number explaining a related operation.  
1
Indicates useful information.  
Indicates precautions to take when operating the camera.  
In this Operating Manual, the buttons of the four-  
way controller are referred to in the following way.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Before Using Your  
Camera  
Check the package contents and the names and functions  
of working parts before use.  
I Characteristics .....................................16  
Using the Mode Dial .............................................45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16  
I Characteristics  
• Features a 23.7×15.7 mm CMOS sensor with approximately 16.28  
million effective pixels for high precision and a wide dynamic range.  
• Features Shake Reduction (SR), an image sensor shifting shake  
reduction system. This enables you to capture sharp pictures with  
minimal camera shake regardless of the lens type.  
1
• Features an AF sensor with 11 focusing points. The central 9 focusing  
points are wide cross area sensors.  
Features a viewfinder similar to that of a conventional 35 mm camera, with  
a magnification of approximately 0.92 and field of view of approximately  
100%, for easier manual focusing. Also features a superimpose function  
in which the active AF point(s) on the viewfinder illuminate red.  
• Features a large 3.0-inch monitor with approximately 921,000 dots, a  
wide viewing angle and brightness and color adjusting functions for  
high-precision viewing performance.  
• Features a Live View function for shooting while viewing the subject in  
real-time on the monitor.  
• Movies can be recorded by taking advantage of the lens properties. The  
camera can also output composite and HDMI video signals so that you  
can watch recorded still pictures and movies on a TV or high-quality  
monitor.  
• A user-friendly design has been implemented in various parts of the  
camera. The large text size, high-contrast monitor and easy-to-use  
menus make the camera easier to operate.  
• The body exterior is magnesium alloy, and the dials, buttons, joints, and  
retractable parts of the camera are dust-proof and water-resistant.  
• Features the Dust Removal function to remove dust on the CMOS  
sensor.  
• Features Hyper-program and Hyper-manual modes that let you take  
pictures with the intended exposure. Also features Sensitivity Priority  
Automatic Exposure mode K that automatically adjusts aperture and  
shutter speed according to the set sensitivity, and Shutter & Aperture  
Priority Automatic Exposure mode L that automatically adjusts  
sensitivity according to the set aperture and shutter speed.  
• Features Digital Filters to internally process the image in the camera.  
You can use digital filters such as Color or Soft while taking pictures or  
to process images after taking them.  
• Features Custom Image which allows you to adjust settings while  
previewing the end result of the edited image, enabling a wider range of  
photographic expression.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
17  
• Records images in the versatile JPEG format or the high quality and fully  
editable RAW format. You can also select JPEG+RAW and record in  
both formats simultaneously. When the file format of the last captured  
image is JPEG, and its data still remains in the buffer memory, you can  
save the image in RAW format. RAW images can be easily processed  
internally by the camera.  
1
• Up to five setting patterns can be saved as A mode. In addition,  
functions for the |/Y button and the e-dials can also be  
customized, enabling speedy operation by any type of photographer.  
• Supports the optional Battery Grip D-BG4 with vertical shutter release  
button. If a battery (D-LI90) is inserted in both the camera and grip, the  
battery with more power is prioritized. This enables you to get the best  
camera performance for an extended period. By using a menu item, you  
can prioritize either one of the batteries in the camera and battery grip,  
and use its full power before switching to the other battery.  
Shake Reduction (SR)  
Shake Reduction (SR) on this camera features a PENTAX original  
system which uses magnetic force to move the image sensor at high  
speeds, compensating for camera shake.  
The camera may generate some operating noise when it is shaken,  
such as when changing the composition of a picture. This is normal  
and not a malfunction.  
The captured area (view angle) will differ between this camera and 35 mm SLR  
cameras even if the same lens is used because the format sizes for 35 mm film  
and CMOS sensor are different.  
Sizes for 35 mm film and CMOS sensor  
35 mm film  
: 36×24 mm  
CMOS sensor on this camera : 23.7×15.7 mm  
The focal length of a lens used with a 35 mm camera is about 1.5 times longer  
than that of this camera. To shoot images with an angle of view framing the same  
area, divide the focal length of the 35 mm lens by 1.5.  
Example) To capture the same image as a 150 mm lens attached to a 35 mm  
camera  
150÷1.5=100  
Use a 100 mm lens with this camera.  
Inversely, multiply the focal length of the lens used with this camera by 1.5 to  
determine the focal length for 35 mm cameras.  
Example) If a 300 mm lens is used with this camera  
300×1.5=450  
The focal length is equivalent to a 450 mm lens on a 35 mm camera.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
18  
About the J  
Compared with the I, the J is superior in its ability to  
express the fine details, which enables taking even higher definition  
images.  
1
Please note the following to enjoy the high resolution of your J  
to the fullest.  
Relationship between High Resolution and Aperture  
When taking photographs in situations where the ability to record fine  
details is important, an open aperture up to an aperture of F8 is  
recommended to reduce the effects of diffraction. Try using an aperture  
higher than F8 in situations where false color or moiré are noticeable.  
False Color and Moiré  
While the J is more suited for expressing fine details than the  
I, false color and moiré are more noticeable.  
For example, when sharpness is emphasized in Custom Image, the image  
may turn out looking unnatural in some cases. Be sure to take pictures  
while adjusting the balance between capturing fine details and image  
processing.  
To check for false color and moiré, transfer images to a computer and view  
them at 100%.  
JPEG Quality  
If you are going to shoot in JPEG with the quality set to E or D, high-  
definition images will not be captured and the ability to record fine details  
will diminish. Set [JPEG Quality] to C or Z as much as possible.  
Camera Shake  
High-definition images cannot be captured if camera shake occurs.  
Prevent camera shake from occurring by using a tripod when necessary.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
19  
Checking the Contents of the  
Package  
The following accessories are packaged with your camera.  
Check that all accessories are included.  
1
Hot shoe cover FK  
Eyecup FR  
ME viewfinder cap  
(Installed on camera)  
(Installed on camera)  
Triangular ring and  
protective cover  
(Installed on camera)  
Sync socket 2P cap  
(Installed on camera)  
Body mount cover  
(Installed on camera)  
Rechargeable lithium-ion  
battery D-LI90  
Battery charger  
D-BC90  
AC plug cord  
USB cable  
I-USB7  
AV cable  
I-AVC7  
Strap  
O-ST132  
Software (CD-ROM)  
S-SW132  
Operating Manual  
(this manual)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
20  
Names and Functions of Working  
Parts  
Built-in flash  
Strap lug  
Hot shoe  
Strap lug  
1
AF assist light  
X-sync socket  
Mirror  
Self-timer lamp/  
Remote control receiver  
AF coupler  
Lens mount index  
Lens unlock button  
Lens information  
contacts  
Diopter adjustment  
lever  
LCD Panel  
Speaker  
Microphone  
Viewfinder  
Image plane  
indicator  
SD Memory Card  
slot  
Microphone terminal  
Mini HDMI terminal  
(Type C)  
Self-timer lamp/  
Remote control  
receiver  
PC/AV terminal  
DC input terminal  
Terminal cover  
Monitor  
Cable release  
terminal  
Card access  
lamp  
Tripod socket  
Battery cover  
unlock knob  
Battery grip contacts  
Battery cover  
* In the first illustration, the camera is shown with the Hot shoe cover FK removed.  
* In the second illustration, the camera is shown with the Hot shoe cover FK and  
the Eyecup FR removed.  
If the terminal covers are not closed correctly, the dust-proof and water-  
resistant qualities of the camera will not be effective.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
21  
Capture Mode  
Functions of buttons and dials used during shooting are noted.  
The factory default setting of each part is explained here, but some parts have  
multiple functions and work differently depending on the selected setting.  
1
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
9
0
a
b
6
e
f
g
h
i
j
k
l
m
c
d
1
2
m (EV Compensation)  
button  
Turn the rear e-dial (S)  
while pressing this button to  
set the EV compensation  
3 Shutter release button  
Press to capture images. (p.67)  
4 Main switch  
Move to turn the power on/off  
(p.59) or to preview (p.118).  
5 Front e-dial (R)  
o button  
Changes the settings.  
You can change the menu  
when a menu screen is  
Turn the rear e-dial (S)  
while pressing this button to  
set the ISO sensitivity. (p.83)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
22  
6 Lens unlock button  
e Rear e-dial (S)  
Press to detach a lens. (p.57)  
Changes the settings.  
You can change the menu  
when a menu screen is  
7
E (Flash pop-up) button  
Press to pop up the built-in  
1
f
g
L button  
8 Mode dial lock button  
Records the exposure before  
preview image.  
Press to allow the mode dial to  
9 Mode dial  
| (Green) button  
Switches the exposure  
modes. (p.45)  
Sets the exposure mode to  
Automatic Exposure and  
resets the settings.  
0 Metering mode switch  
Changes the metering  
method. (p.103)  
h AF point switching dial  
Sets the focusing area. (p.113)  
a
|/Y button  
You can assign a function to  
this button. (p.249)  
i
= button  
Sets the focusing area and  
temporarily provides manual  
focus. (p.110)  
b Focus mode switch  
Switches between autofocus  
j
k
U (Live View) button  
Displays a Live View image.  
modes (l/k) (p.108)  
and manual focus mode  
(p.116).  
4 button  
c
d
Q (Playback) button  
Switches to Playback mode.  
When the control panel or a  
menu screen is displayed,  
press this button to confirm  
the selected item.  
M button  
Changes the style of the  
display on the monitor. (p.26)  
When the AF point switching  
dial is set to j (Select),  
press this button to enable or  
disable changing the AF point.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
23  
l Four-way controller  
m
3 button  
(2345)  
Displays the [A Rec. Mode 1]  
menu (p.79). Press this button  
when a menu screen is  
displayed to return to the  
previous screen.  
Displays the Drive Mode/Flash  
Mode/White Balance/Custom  
Image setup menu. (p.78)  
1
When the control panel or a  
menu screen is displayed, use  
this to move the cursor or  
change items.  
When the AF point switching dial  
is set to  
j
(Select), use this  
to change the AF point. (p.114)  
Playback Mode  
Functions of buttons and dials used during playback are noted.  
1
2
3
4
8
9
0
5
6
a
b
c
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
24  
1
m (EV Compensation)  
9
L button  
button  
When the file format of the last  
captured image is JPEG, and  
its data still remains in the  
buffer memory, press this  
button to save the image in  
Press in the enlarged view to  
increase the magnification.  
(p.211)  
1
2 Shutter release button  
Press halfway to switch to  
Capture mode.  
0
a
| (Green) button  
Press in the enlarged view to  
decrease the magnification.  
(p.211)  
3 Main switch  
Move to turn the camera on  
4 button  
4 Front e-dial (R)  
Confirms the setting you  
selected in the menu screen  
or playback screen.  
Use this to display the next or  
previous image.  
5
6
i (Delete) button  
Press to delete images. (p.74)  
b Four-way controller  
(2345)  
When a menu screen or  
playback screen is displayed,  
use this to move the cursor or  
change items.  
Press the four-way controller  
(3) to display the playback  
Q (Playback) button  
Press to switch to Capture  
mode.  
7
M button  
Changes the style of the  
display on the monitor. (p.30)  
8 Rear e-dial (S)  
c
3 button  
Use this to change the  
magnification in the enlarged  
view (p.211) or display  
multiple images at the same  
Press to display the  
[Q Playback 1] menu  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
25  
Monitor  
The various information appears on the monitor depending on the status  
of the camera.  
1
The brightness and the color of the monitor can be adjusted. (p.260, p.261)  
At Start-up or when Operating the Mode Dial  
Guides appear on the monitor for 3 seconds (default setting) when the  
camera is switched on or the mode dial is turned.  
Program  
Automatic Exposure  
P
1
RAW RAW  
P
Tv  
Av  
2
AF Enable AF  
10/10/2012  
10:30AM  
3
4
1
2
Exposure Mode (p.88)  
Guide indicator  
3
4
World Time (p.253)  
Current date and time (p.62)  
* 3 appears only when [World Time] is set to [Destination].  
• Select [Off] for [Guide Display] in the [R Set-up 1] menu to not show guides.  
(p.257)  
• When the mode dial is set to A, the screen for selecting one of the A  
modes from A1 to A5 is displayed for 30 seconds regardless of the  
[Guide Display] setting. (p.205)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
26  
Capture Mode  
While shooting, the status screen is displayed showing the current  
shooting function settings. You can change the type of the screen  
displayed by pressing the M button.  
1
ISO AUTO Setting  
Adjustment Range  
AF.S  
P
M
1/2000 F2.8  
ISO  
200-1600  
OFF  
11  
AUTO  
0.0  
ISO  
AUTO 1600  
OFF  
OFF  
0
0
HDR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
-5  
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
JPEG  
16M  
AWB  
[
]
[
]
JPEG 16M  
37  
37  
Status screen  
Control panel  
M
M
M
Blank  
Electronic level display  
[Electronic Level] is P (Off) by default. Set in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu.  
(p.262)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
27  
 Status screen  
(All items are displayed here for explanatory purposes. The actual display may differ.)  
1
P USER  
SHIFT  
1
2
9
3
4
5
6
7
AF.S  
1/2000 F2.8  
10  
8
8
8
23  
1
+1.0  
G1A1  
ISO  
11  
12  
14  
AUTO  
1600  
24  
25  
26  
13  
8
-
5 4 3 2 1  
1 2  
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
15  
19  
16  
20  
17  
21  
18  
22  
JPEG  
[
]
16M  
1234  
1
2
3
Exposure Mode (p.88)  
AE Lock (p.107)  
Interval Shooting (p.133)/Multi-  
exposure (p.136)/Extended  
Bracketing (p.141)/Digital Filter  
(p.143)/HDR Capture (p.191)  
14 EV bar  
15 Flash Mode (p.69)  
16 Drive Mode (p.78)  
17 White Balance (p.183)  
18 Custom Image (p.197)  
19 File Format (p.180)  
4
Shake Reduction (p.122)/  
Horizon Correction (p.123)  
20 JPEG Recorded Pixels (p.178)  
21 JPEG Quality (p.179)  
5
6
7
8
9
Focus Mode (p.108)  
Metering Method (p.103)  
Battery level (p.51)  
E-dial guide  
22 GPS positioning status  
23 Flash Exposure Compensation  
(p.71)  
24 White Balance fine-tuning (p.184)/  
Cross Processing (p.200)  
Shutter speed  
10 Aperture value  
11 ISO/ISO AUTO  
12 Sensitivity (p.83)  
25 AF point (p.113)  
26 Remaining image storage  
capacity/| button guide  
13 EV Compensation (p.105)/  
Exposure Bracketing (p.138)  
* Indicator 22 appears only when the optional GPS unit is attached to the  
camera and is operating. (p.305)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
28  
 Control panel  
Press the M button in the status screen to display the control panel and change  
settings. (p.41)  
ISO AUTO Setting  
1
Adjustment Range  
1
ISO  
2
5
3
7
200-1600  
OFF  
11  
AUTO  
OFF  
OFF  
4
8
6
HDR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
9
10  
14  
11  
15  
12  
13  
JPEG  
16M  
[
]
16  
17  
37  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Function name  
ISO AUTO Setting (p.84)  
AUTO AF Point Setting (p.113)  
Highlight Correction (p.190)  
Shadow Correction (p.190)  
Distortion Correction (p.193)  
10 Digital Filter (p.143)  
11 HDR Capture (p.191)  
12 File Format (p.180)  
13 JPEG Recorded Pixels (p.178)  
14 JPEG Quality (p.179)  
15 Shake Reduction (p.122)  
16 Current date and time  
17 Remaining image storage  
Lateral Chromatic Aberration  
Adjustment (p.193)  
capacity  
8
9
Cross Processing (p.200)  
Extended Bracketing (p.141)  
• Settings that cannot be changed due to the current camera setup cannot be  
selected.  
• When [Status Screen] (p.258) in the [R Set-up 1] menu is set to P (Off), the  
status screen is not displayed.  
• On the status screen, the setting currently being changed or guide display for  
the buttons that can be operated are displayed in blue (when [Status Screen]  
(p.258) in the [R Set-up 1] menu is set to [Display Color 1]).  
• The status screen will disappear if no operations are made within 30  
seconds. Press the M button to display it again.  
• If no operations are made within 30 seconds in the control panel, the status  
screen will reappear.  
• [9999] is the maximum number of recordable images that can be displayed on  
the status screen and in the control panel. Even if the number of recordable  
images is 10,000 or more, [9999] is displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
29  
Electronic level display  
This camera is equipped with an electronic level for detecting whether  
the camera is level. When [Electronic Level] is set to O (On), press  
the M button while the control panel is displayed to view the  
electronic level. When [Electronic Level] is assigned to the |/Y  
button, press the |/Y button to switch the display on/off.  
A bar graph indicating the horizontal camera angle appears at the  
bottom of the screen, and a bar graph indicating the vertical camera  
angle appears on the right side.  
1
Example:  
Horizontally and vertically  
level (green)  
Tilted 1.5° to the left (yellow)  
Vertically level (green)  
Outside horizontal level  
display (red)  
Tilted 5° up (yellow)  
Horizontally level (green)  
Outside vertical level  
display (red)  
• [Electronic Level] is P (Off) by default. Set in the [A Rec. Mode 4]  
menu. (p.262)  
• Refer to p.249 for assigning a function to the |/Y button.  
• The electronic level display will disappear if no operations are made  
within 1 minute.  
• If the camera angle cannot be detected, both ends and the center of  
the bar graphs flash red.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
30  
When holding the camera vertically  
If the camera is held vertically while measuring  
the brightness, the status screen or control  
panel is displayed vertically. The directions of  
the four-way controller (2345) also change  
to match the orientation of the camera.  
To always display the contents of the screen  
horizontally, set in [Status Screen] of the [R  
Set-up 1] menu. (p.258)  
ISO AUTO Setting  
Adjustment Range  
ISO  
200-1600  
OFF  
AUTO  
1
OFF  
11  
OFF  
HDR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
JPEG  
16M  
[
]
1234  
Playback Mode  
The camera switches the types of information display when you press the  
M button during playback.  
Standard  
Captured image, file format, and guides are displayed.  
Captured image and histogram (Brightness/RGB) are  
displayed. Not available during movie playback. (p.33)  
Histogram display  
Detailed  
Detailed information on how and when the image was taken  
information display is displayed. (p.31)  
No info. display Only captured image is displayed.  
100-0001  
100-0001  
AE-L RAW  
AE-L RAW  
M
1/2000 F5.6  
ISO  
200  
1/  
2000 F5.6 ISO 200  
JPEG  
Standard  
Histogram display  
M
M
100-0001  
P
M
24mm  
0
0
AF.C  
1/  
ON  
ON  
ON  
2000  
0
0
0
F2.8  
ISO 200  
+1.5  
-0.5  
G2A1  
JPEG 16M  
AdobeRGB  
10/10/2012 10:00AM  
No info. display  
Detailed information display  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
31  
The type of information display that is shown first during playback is the same  
as that of the last playback in the previous session. If [Playback Info Display] is  
set to P (Off) in [Memory] of the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu, the [Standard] screen  
is always displayed first when the camera is turned on. (p.274)  
 Detailed information display  
1
Use the four-way controller (23) to switch between pages.  
(All items are displayed here for explanatory purposes. The actual display may differ.)  
Page 1  
Still Picture  
1
3
7
4
5
6
100-0001  
P
2
30  
31  
8
10  
0
0
0
0
0
9
24mm  
AF.C  
1/  
2000  
11 12  
ON  
ON  
ON  
13 14 15 16 17 18 19  
20  
23  
21  
24  
22  
25  
F2.8  
ISO 200  
+1.5  
-0.5  
G2A1  
26 27 28  
32  
29  
33  
JPEG 16M  
AdobeRGB  
10/10/2012 10:00AM  
Movie  
3
5
6
100-0001  
2
30  
31  
10min10sec  
34  
25  
0
0
0
0
0
24  
14 38  
35 36  
20  
MONO  
G2A1  
OFF  
37  
F2.8  
FullHD  
26 27 28  
32  
4
Movie  
25  
10/10/2012 10:00AM  
2
3
2
3
Page 2  
Still Picture/Movie  
1
5
6
100-0001  
2
40  
41  
39  
39  
42  
44  
43  
45  
N
36°45.410'  
0m  
W140°02.000'  
123°  
10/10/2012  
10:00:00  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
32  
1
2
3
4
Rotation information (p.219)  
Captured image  
Exposure Mode (p.88)  
Shake Reduction (p.122)/  
Horizon Correction (p.123)  
22 Flash Exposure Compensation  
(p.71)  
23 Sensitivity (p.83)  
24 White Balance (p.183)  
25 White Balance fine-tuning (p.184  
26 File Format (p.180)  
27 Recorded Pixels (p.152, p.178)  
28 Quality Level (p.152, p.179)  
29 Color Space (p.189)  
)
1
5
6
Protect (p.222)  
Folder number-File number  
(p.263)  
7
8
9
Drive Mode (p.78)  
Flash Mode (p.69)  
Focal Length  
30 Image finishing tone (p.197)  
31 Custom Image parameters  
(p.198)  
10 AF point (p.113)/  
Autofocus Method (p.147)  
32 Shooting date and time  
33 DPOF settings (p.271)  
34 Recording time  
35 Sound setting (p.153)  
36 Sound type  
11 Focus Mode (p.108)  
12 Metering Method (p.103)  
13 Shutter speed  
14 Digital Filter (p.143)  
15 Multi-exposure (p.136)/  
Extended Bracketing (p.141)/  
HDR Capture (p.191)/  
37 Drive Mode (Remote Control)  
38 Cross Processing (p.200)  
39 Information tampering warning  
40 Photographer (p.269)  
41 Copyright Holder (p.269)  
42 Latitude  
Cross Processing (p.200)  
16 Highlight Correction (p.190)  
17 Shadow Correction (p.190)  
18 Distortion Correction (p.193)  
43 Altitude  
19 Lateral Chromatic Aberration  
44 Longitude  
Adjustment (p.193)  
45 Lens direction  
20 Aperture value  
46 Universal Coordinated Time  
21 EV Compensation (p.105)  
* Indicators 42 to 46 appear only for images in which GPS information is  
stored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
33  
 Histogram display  
The following histograms can be displayed when playing back still  
pictures. The “Brightness histogram” shows the distribution of brightness  
and the “RGB histogram” shows the distribution of color intensity. Press  
the four-way controller (23) to switch between “Brightness histogram”  
and “RGB histogram”.  
1
1
2
3
4
4
2
3
100-0001  
100-0001  
AE-L RAW  
23  
23  
11  
12  
13  
AE-L RAW  
5
1
5
1/2000 F5.6 ISO 200  
1/2000 F5.6 ISO 200  
6
7
8
9
10  
6
7
8
9
10  
Brightness histogram  
RGB histogram  
1
2
3
4
5
Histogram (Brightness)  
Protect  
Folder number-File number  
Save RAW data  
Switch RGB histogram/  
Brightness histogram  
7
8
9
Shutter speed  
Aperture value  
Sensitivity  
10 DPOF settings  
11 Histogram (R)  
12 Histogram (G)  
13 Histogram (B)  
6
File Format  
* Indicator 2 appears only for protected images.  
* Indicator 4 appears only when the file format of the last captured image is  
JPEG, and its data still remains in the buffer memory. (p.74)  
If [Bright/Dark Area] (p.210) in the [Q Playback 1] menu is set to O (On),  
areas affected by bright or dark portions blink (except when in RGB histogram  
display and Detailed information display).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
34  
Using the Histogram  
A histogram shows the brightness  
distribution of an image. The  
horizontal axis represents brightness  
(dark at the left and bright at the right)  
and the vertical axis represents the  
number of pixels.  
1
The shape and the distribution of the  
histogram before and after shooting  
tell you whether the exposure level  
and contrast are correct or not, and  
(Dark) Brightness(Bright)  
Dark portions Bright portions  
lets you decide if you need to adjust the exposure and take a picture again.  
When the image is too dark, the part to the left is cut off (dark portions with  
no detail) and when the image is too bright, the part to the right is cut off  
(bright portions with no detail).  
Bright portions blink red and dark portions blink yellow on the monitor  
when [Bright/Dark Area] is O (On).  
Distribution of color intensity is displayed for each color in the RGB  
histogram. The right side of the graphs look similar for images that have  
White Balance adjusted well. If only one color is lopsided to the left, that  
color is too intense.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
35  
Guide Indicators  
The following indicators appear on the monitor to indicate the keys,  
buttons and e-dials that can be operated at that time.  
Example:  
1
2
3
Four-way controller (2)  
Four-way controller (3)  
Four-way controller (4)  
Four-way controller (5)  
Front e-dial  
4 button  
|
Green button  
L button  
i button  
4
5
R
S
Shutter release button  
|/Y button  
Rear e-dial  
3 button  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
36  
Viewfinder  
The following information appears in the viewfinder.  
2
3
1
1
1
4 5  
6
7
8
9
10  
11 12  
13  
14 15 16 17 18 19  
1
2
3
4
AF frame  
Spot metering frame (p.104)  
AF point (p.113)  
Flash indicator (p.69)  
Lit:  
when the flash is available.  
Blinks: when the flash is recommended but not set or is being charged.  
5
6
Focus Mode (p.116)  
Appears when the focus mode is set to \.  
Shutter speed  
Underlined when the shutter speed can be adjusted.  
Displays a countdown of processing time when the Noise Reduction  
function is activated. (p.85)  
7
8
9
Aperture value  
Underlined when the aperture value can be adjusted.  
[nr] blinks when the Noise Reduction function is activated. (p.85)  
Focus indicator (p.67)  
Lit:  
when the subject is focused.  
Blinks: when the subject is not in focus.  
EV bar  
Displays the EV compensation values or difference between the  
appropriate and current exposure values when the exposure mode is set to  
a or M. (p.105)  
Displays the camera angle when [Electronic Level] is O (On). (p.39)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
37  
10 ISO/ISO AUTO  
Appears when the sensitivity is displayed.  
11 Sensitivity/Remaining image storage capacity  
Underlined when the sensitivity can be adjusted.  
Displays the number of recordable images immediately after shooting.  
Displays the compensation value while adjusting the EV compensation.  
Displays the amount of deviation from the correct exposure when the  
exposure mode is set to a or M and [Electronic Level] is set to O (On).  
(p.100)  
1
12 AE Lock (p.107)  
Appears while the AE Lock function is activated.  
13 Changing AF point (p.114)  
Appears when the AF point can be changed with the AF point switching dial  
set to j (Select).  
14 Multi-exposure (p.136)  
Appears when Multi-exposure is set.  
15 Metering Method (p.103)  
Appears when the metering method is M (Center-weighted metering) or  
N (Spot metering).  
16 Shake Reduction (p.122)  
Appears when the Shake Reduction function is activated.  
17 Flash Exposure Compensation (p.71)  
Appears when the flash exposure compensation is in use.  
18 EV Compensation (p.105)/Exposure Bracketing (p.138)  
Appears when adjusting the EV compensation or when the drive mode is  
set to [Exposure Bracketing].  
19 File Format (p.180)  
Displays the image save format in RAW/RAW+ format.  
Not displayed in JPEG format.  
• The information is displayed in the viewfinder when the shutter release button  
is pressed halfway and during the meter operating time (default setting: 10  
sec.). (p.104)  
• The AF point(s) in use for autofocus appear in red (Superimpose AF Area)  
when the shutter release button is pressed halfway. (p.113)  
• When [Cancel AF] is assigned to [AF Button] in [Button Customization] of the  
[A Rec. Mode 5] menu, \ is displayed in the viewfinder while the =  
button is pressed. (p.110)  
• [9999] is the maximum number of recordable images that can be displayed  
in the viewfinder. Even if the number of recordable images is 10,000 or more,  
[9999] is displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
38  
LCD Panel  
The following information appears in the LCD panel on top of the camera.  
1
3 4  
5
1
2
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
1
2
Shutter speed/  
Countdown of Noise Reduction  
processing time (p.85)  
11 Flash Mode (p.78)  
b
: Built-in flash is ready  
(when blinking, flash  
should be used)  
Aperture value  
nr  
:
Noise Reduction is  
activated (p.85)  
>
3
: Red-eye Reduction  
: Auto Flash Discharge  
3
4
5
Multi-exposure (p.136)  
Mirror Lock-up Shooting (p.130)  
EV bar (p.105)/  
Q : Slow-speed Sync  
E
: Trailing Curtain Sync  
: Wireless  
w
Electronic Level (p.39)  
12 Drive Mode (p.78)  
6
EV Compensation (p.105)/  
Exposure Bracketing (p.138)  
9
j
g
W
: Single Frame Shooting  
: Continuous Shooting  
: Self-timer Shooting  
7
8
Battery level (p.51)  
Flash Exposure Compensation  
:
Remote Control Shooting  
13 File Format (p.180)  
: RAW capture  
9
Sensitivity/EV compensation  
value  
1
1P: RAW+JPEG capture  
14 Remaining image storage  
capacity/USB Connection mode  
(p.279)  
10 ISO/ISO AUTO  
Appears when the sensitivity is  
displayed.  
Pc-S : MSC mode  
Pc-P : PTP mode  
LCD panel is illuminated when the exposure metering is performed. You can  
choose [High], [Low] or [Off] for LCD panel backlight in [22. LCD Panel  
Illumination] of the [A Custom Setting 4] menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
39  
Electronic level display  
When the camera is not level, a bar graph indicating the horizontal  
camera angle is displayed in the viewfinder and on the LCD panel.  
1
When level (at 0°)  
When tilted 5° to the left  
When held vertically and tilted 3° to the right  
• [Electronic Level] is P (Off) by default. Set in the [A Rec. Mode 4]  
menu. (p.262)  
• The composition can also be adjusted in the camera when the camera  
is stabilized using a tripod. (p.195)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
40  
How to Change Function Settings  
Function settings can be changed using the direct keys, control panel or  
menus. Some functions can be changed using both the control panel and  
menus.  
1
This section explains the basic ways to change function settings.  
Using the Direct Keys  
In Capture mode, you can set Drive Mode, Flash Mode, White Balance and  
Custom Image by pressing the four-way controller (2345). (p.78)  
Below, how to set [Flash Mode] is explained as an example.  
1
Press the four-way controller (3)  
in Capture mode.  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select a flash mode.  
Flash Mode  
Flash On  
0.0  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
41  
While direct key operation is enabled, the guide indicators for the direct keys  
are displayed in blue (when [Status Screen] (p.258) in the [R Set-up 1] menu  
is set to [Display Color 1]). Direct key operation is not available when the AF  
point switching dial is set to j and the AF point is being changed. In such  
cases, press and hold the 4 button. (p.114)  
1
Using the Control Panel  
While shooting, the current settings can be checked on the status screen.  
You can also switch the display to the control panel and change settings.  
Following, how to set [JPEG Quality] is explained as an example.  
1
Check the status screen and then  
press the M button.  
The control panel appears.  
Press the M button when the status  
screen is not displayed.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller  
(2345) to select an item you  
want to change the setting for.  
ISO AUTO Setting  
Adjustment Range  
ISO  
200-1600  
OFF  
11  
AUTO  
OFF  
OFF  
Items that cannot be changed for the  
current camera settings appear grayed  
out and cannot be selected.  
HDR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
JPEG  
16M  
[
]
37  
Use the front e-dial (R) or rear  
e-dial (S) to change the  
setting.  
JPEG Quality  
ISO  
200-1600  
OFF  
11  
AUTO  
OFF  
HDR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
JPEG  
16M  
[
]
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
42  
4
Press the 3 button or the  
shutter release button halfway.  
The camera returns to the status screen  
and is ready to take a picture.  
1
• Press the 4 button in Step 3 to display the detailed setting screen for the  
selected item. Make the detailed settings for functions such as Extended  
Bracketing and Digital Filter on the detailed setting screen.  
• The status screen and control panel are not displayed when Live View  
(p.146) is displayed. Make or change necessary settings in the [A Rec.  
Mode] menu in advance.  
Using the Menus  
This section explains how to use the menus: [A Rec. Mode],  
[Q Playback], [R Set-up] and [A Custom Setting] menus.  
Following, how to set [Program Line] in the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu is  
explained as an example.  
1
Press the 3 button in  
Capture mode.  
The [A Rec. Mode 1] menu appears on  
the monitor.  
If the  
3
button is pressed in  
Playback mode, the [  
menu appears.  
Q
Playback 1]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
43  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
twice or turn the rear e-dial (S)  
two clicks to the right (toward  
y).  
1
2
3
4
5
File Format  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
AF Settings  
Lens Correction  
JPEG  
16M  
1
Each time the four-way controller (5) is  
pressed, the menu will change in the  
following sequence: [A Rec. Mode 2],  
[A Rec. Mode 3], [A Rec. Mode 4],  
MENU Exit  
[A Rec. Mode 5], [Q Playback 1] … [A Rec. Mode 1].  
When the front e-dial (R) is turned to the right, the menu will change  
in the following sequence: [A Rec. Mode 1], [Q Playback 1],  
[R Set-up 1], [A Custom Setting 1].  
3
4
5
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to choose an item.  
1
2
3
4 5  
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
ISO  
NR  
AUTO  
AUTO  
NR  
Color Space  
RAW File Format  
sRGB  
PEF  
MENU  
Exit  
Press the four-way controller  
(5).  
1
2
3
4 5  
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
ISO  
Available settings are displayed in the  
pop-up menu or submenu.  
AUTO  
NR  
AUTO  
NR  
Color Space  
RAW File Format  
sRGB  
PEF  
MENU  
Exit  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a setting.  
1
2
3
4 5  
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
Press the 3 button to cancel the  
pop-up menu, or return to the previous  
screen.  
Color Space  
RAW File Format  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
44  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The setting is saved.  
Press the 3 button if a submenu is  
displayed.  
1
Next, set other items.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before  
selecting the menu appears again.  
Even after you press the 3 button and close the menu screen, your  
settings will not be saved if the camera is turned off improperly (such as by  
removing the battery while the camera is on).  
• You can select whether to display the menu tab selected the last time first, or  
to always display the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu first. (p.258)  
• Refer to the following pages for details on each menu.  
• [A Rec. Mode] menu  
• [Q Playback] menu  
• [R Set-up] menu  
• [A Custom Setting] menu 1p.81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
45  
Using the Mode Dial  
You can switch the exposure modes by setting the icons on the mode dial  
to the dial indicator.  
Turn the mode dial while pressing the mode dial lock button.  
1
Dial indicator  
Mode dial  
Mode dial lock button  
Mode  
Characteristics  
Page  
Lets you capture images with fully automatic  
settings.  
B
Green  
Automatically sets the shutter speed and aperture value to  
obtain a proper exposure according to Program Line when  
taking pictures. You can use the front and rear e-dials to  
switch between shutter priority and aperture priority.  
e
Program Automatic  
Exposure  
K
Sensitivity Priority  
Automatically sets the shutter speed and aperture  
value to obtain a proper exposure according to the p.92  
Automatic Exposure set sensitivity.  
b
Lets you set the desired shutter speed for  
expressing the movement of the subject.  
Shutter Priority  
Automatic Exposure  
c
Lets you set the desired aperture value for  
controlling the depth of field.  
Aperture Priority  
Automatic Exposure  
L
Automatically sets the sensitivity to obtain a proper  
Shutter & Aperture Priority exposure with the set shutter speed and aperture  
Automatic Exposure  
value according to the brightness of the subject.  
a
Lets you set the shutter speed and aperture value  
to capture the picture with creative intent.  
Manual Exposure  
p
Lets you capture images that require slow shutter  
speeds such as fireworks and night scenes.  
Bulb Exposure  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
46  
Mode  
Characteristics  
Page  
The shutter speed is locked at 1/180 second. Use  
this when using an external flash that does not  
automatically set the sync speed.  
M
Flash X-sync Speed  
Lets you capture images with the saved exposure  
mode. Up to five settings can be saved.  
A
1
C
Movie  
Use this to record movies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Getting Started  
This chapter explains your first steps from purchasing the  
camera to taking pictures. Be sure to read it and follow the  
instructions.  
Attaching the Strap ..............................................48  
Inserting the Battery ............................................49  
Attaching a Lens ..................................................56  
Turning the Camera On and Off ..........................59  
Initial Settings .......................................................60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
48  
Attaching the Strap  
1
Pass the end of the strap through  
the protective cover and  
triangular ring.  
2
2
Secure the end of the strap on the inside of the clasp.  
3
Attach the other end of the strap in the same manner as  
described above.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
49  
Inserting the Battery  
Insert the battery into the camera. Use only a D-LI90 battery.  
Charging the Battery  
2
When using the battery for the first time, or when the battery has not been  
used in a long time, or when [Battery depleted] appears, recharge the  
battery.  
Note: AC plug cord “Listed, Type SPT-2 or NISPT-2, 18/2 flexible  
cord, rated 125 V, 7A, minimum 6ft (1.8m)”  
Indicator lamp  
Lithium-ion battery  
3
2
AC plug cord  
1
Battery charger  
1
Connect the AC plug cord to the battery charger.  
Plug the AC plug cord into the power outlet.  
2
3
Face the 2 mark on the battery up and insert it into the  
battery charger.  
The indicator lamp is lit during charging and turns off when the battery is  
fully charged.  
4
When the battery is fully charged, remove the battery from  
the battery charger.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
50  
• Do not use the provided battery charger D-BC90 to charge batteries other  
than D-LI90. Charging other batteries may cause damage or heating.  
• Replace the battery with a new one in the following cases:  
- If the indicator lamp blinks or does not light after the battery is inserted  
correctly  
- If the battery starts to run down more quickly even after being charged (the  
battery may have reached the end of its service life)  
The maximum charging time is approximately 390 minutes (it depends on  
temperature and remaining battery power.) Charge in a location where the  
temperature is between 0°C and 40°C.  
2
Inserting/Removing the Battery  
• Do not open the battery cover or remove the battery while the power is on.  
• Insert the battery correctly. Inserting the battery incorrectly may cause a  
camera breakdown. Wipe the electrodes of the battery with a soft dry cloth  
before inserting.  
• Be careful as the camera or battery may become hot when the camera is  
used continuously for a long period of time.  
• Remove the battery when you will not use the camera for a long while. The  
battery may leak and damage the camera if left installed during prolonged  
periods of non-use. If the removed battery will not be used for six months or  
longer, charge the battery for about 30 minutes before storing it. Be sure to  
recharge the battery every six to twelve months.  
• Store the battery in a location where the temperature will remain below room  
temperature. Avoid locations with high temperatures.  
• The date and time may be reset if you leave the battery out of the camera for  
long periods of time. If this occurs, follow the procedure described in “Setting  
the Date and Time” (p.62) to set the current date and time.  
1
Open the battery cover.  
2
1
Lift the battery cover unlock knob, turn it  
towards OPEN (1) to unlock, and then  
pull the cover open (2).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
51  
2
3
Face the 2 mark on the battery towards outside of the  
camera, push the battery lock lever in the direction of the  
arrow (3) and insert the battery.  
Insert until the battery locks.  
To remove the battery, push the  
battery lock lever in the direction  
of the arrow (3) with your finger.  
2
3
Battery lock lever  
Close the battery cover (4) and  
4
turn the battery cover unlock  
5
knob towards CLOSE (5) to  
lock.  
Stow the battery cover unlock knob after  
closing the battery cover.  
Battery Level Indicator  
You can confirm remaining battery level by checking the w/A  
displayed on the status screen and LCD panel.  
Status  
LCD Panel  
Battery Level  
Screen  
w (Green)  
x (Green)  
y (Yellow)  
F (Red)  
A
Battery is full.  
B
Battery is close to full.  
Battery is running low.  
Battery is almost empty.  
C
D lit  
The camera turns off after displaying the  
message.  
(D continues blinking on the LCD  
panel.)  
[Battery depleted]  
D blinks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
52  
y, F, C or D may appear even when the battery level is  
sufficient if the camera is used at low temperatures or when performing  
continuous shooting for a long period of time.  
• Battery performance temporarily decreases as the temperature decreases.  
When using the camera in cold climates, have extra batteries on hand and  
keep them warm in your pocket. Battery performance will return to normal  
when returned to room temperature.  
• Have extra batteries ready when traveling overseas, taking pictures in cold  
climates, or taking a lot of pictures.  
2
Using the AC Adapter (Optional)  
We recommend the use of the AC adapter kit K-AC132 (optional) when  
using the monitor for a long time or when connecting the camera to a  
computer or AV device.  
The AC Adapter Kit K-AC132 includes AC Adapter D-AC120 and AC plug cord.  
1
Make sure the camera is turned off.  
Open the terminal cover.  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
53  
3
Face the 2 mark on the DC  
terminal of the AC adapter  
towards the 2 mark on the  
camera, and connect the DC  
terminal to the DC input terminal  
of the camera.  
2
4
5
Connect the AC plug cord to the AC adapter.  
Plug the AC cord into the power outlet.  
• Make sure the camera is turned off before connecting or disconnecting the  
AC adapter.  
• Make sure connections are secure between the terminals. The SD Memory  
Card or data may be corrupted if disconnected while the card is being  
accessed.  
W is displayed on the status screen when using the AC adapter.  
• Be sure to read the manual of the AC adapter kit before using the AC adapter.  
• The battery in your camera will not charge when connected to the AC  
adapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
54  
Inserting/Removing an SD Memory  
Card  
This camera uses a commercially available SD Memory Card, SDHC  
Memory Card, or SDXC Memory Card.  
Make sure the camera is turned off before inserting or removing the SD  
Memory Card.  
• Do not remove the SD Memory Card while the card access lamp is lit.  
• Use this camera to format (initialize) an SD Memory Card that is unused or  
has been used on other cameras or digital devices. Refer to “Formatting the  
SD Memory Card” (p.246) for details on formatting.  
2
• Use a high-speed memory card when recording movies. If a write speed  
cannot keep up with a recording speed, the writing may stop during  
recording.  
1
Make sure the camera is turned off.  
2
Slide the card cover in the  
direction of the arrow and then  
lift it to open (1´2).  
1
2
3
Insert the card all the way with  
the SD Memory Card label facing  
toward the monitor.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
55  
Push the SD Memory Card in once to  
remove.  
2
4
Close the card cover and then  
slide it in the direction of the  
arrow (3´4).  
4
3
Be sure to fully close the card cover. The camera will not turn on if the card  
cover is open.  
For details on the approximate number of still pictures and amount of time of  
movies that can be recorded on an SD Memory Card, refer to “Approximate  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
56  
Attaching a Lens  
Attach a proper lens to the camera’s body.  
When you use one of the following lenses with this camera, all the  
camera’s exposure modes will be available.  
(a) DA, DA L, D FA, FA J lenses  
(b) Lenses with an s (Auto) position, when used in the s position  
2
• Turn the camera off before attaching or removing the lens to prevent  
unexpected lens movement.  
• When attaching or removing a lens, choose an environment that is relatively  
free of dirt and dust.  
• Keep the body mount cover on the camera when a lens is not attached.  
• Be sure to attach the lens mount cover and lens cap to the lens after  
removing the lens from the camera.  
• The camera body and lens mount incorporate lens information contacts and  
an AF coupler. Dirt, dust, or corrosion may damage the electrical system.  
When necessary, clean the contacts with a soft dry cloth.  
• When lenses described in (b) are used in a position other than s, some  
functions will be restricted. Refer to “Using the Aperture Ring” (p.299).  
• With factory default setting, the camera will not work with lenses other than  
those listed above and accessories. Set [27. Using Aperture Ring] to  
[Permitted] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu to use them. (p.299)  
• We assume no responsibility nor liability for accidents, damages and  
malfunctions resulting from the use of lenses made by other manufacturers.  
1
Make sure the camera is turned off.  
2
Remove the body mount cover  
(1) and lens mount cover (2).  
Be sure to put the lens down with the lens  
mount side facing upward to protect the  
lens mount from damage when there is  
no lens mount cover on the lens.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
57  
3
4
Align the Lens mount index (red  
dots; 3) on the camera and the  
lens, and secure by turning the  
lens clockwise until it clicks.  
After attaching, turn the lens  
counterclockwise to check that the lens is  
locked in place.  
3
2
Remove the front lens cap by  
pushing the indicated portions  
inward.  
To remove the lens  
Attach the lens cap first, and then turn the  
lens counterclockwise while holding  
down the lens unlock button (4).  
4
The body mount cover (1) is a cover to prevent scratches and block dust when  
shipped. Body Mount Cap K is sold separately and has a lock function.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
58  
Adjusting the Viewfinder Diopter  
You can adjust the viewfinder diopter to suit your eyesight.  
The Eyecup FR is attached to the viewfinder portion when the camera  
leaves the factory. The diopter can be adjusted with the eyecup attached.  
However, adjustment is easier with the eyecup removed.  
2
1
Remove the eyecup by pulling it  
out in the direction of the arrow.  
2
Look through the viewfinder and  
slide the diopter adjustment lever  
left or right.  
Adjust the lever until the AF frame in the  
viewfinder is focused.  
Point the camera at a white wall or other  
bright and consistent surface.  
AF frame  
If it is difficult to see the viewfinder image clearly even if you use the diopter  
adjustment lever, use the optional diopter correction lens adapter M. However,  
the Eyecup FR must be removed to use this adapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
59  
Turning the Camera On and Off  
1
Turn the main switch to [ON].  
The camera will turn on.  
Set the main switch to the position [OFF]  
to turn off the camera.  
2
• Always turn the camera off when not in use.  
• The power will automatically turn off when you do not perform any operations  
within a set period of time. To reactivate the camera, turn it on again or  
perform any of the following.  
- Press the shutter release button halfway.  
- Press the Q button, 3 button or M button.  
• By default, the camera is set to turn off automatically after 1 minute of  
inactivity. You can change the setting in [Auto Power Off] of the [R Set-up 3]  
menu. (p.266)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
60  
Initial Settings  
The first time the camera is turned on after purchasing, the [Language/  
u] screen appears on the monitor. Follow the procedure below to set  
the language displayed on the monitor and the current date and time.  
If the [Date Adjustment] screen appears, set  
Date Adjustment  
the date and time by following the procedure  
Date Format  
Date  
mm/dd/yy  
01/01/2012  
24h  
2
Time  
:
00 00  
Settings complete  
MENU Cancel  
Setting the Display Language  
You can choose the language in which the menus, error messages, etc. are  
displayed from the following: English, French, German, Spanish, Portuguese,  
Italian, Dutch, Danish, Swedish, Finnish, Polish, Czech, Hungarian, Turkish,  
Greek, Russian, Korean, Traditional Chinese, Simplified Chinese and Japanese.  
1
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select the desired  
language.  
2
Press the 4 button.  
The [Initial Setting] screen appears in the  
selected language.  
Initial Setting  
English  
Press the four-way controller (3) twice and  
proceed to Step 10 on p.61 if W  
New York  
(Hometown) does not have to be changed.  
Text Size  
Settings complete  
Cancel  
Standard  
MENU  
3
4
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The cursor moves to W.  
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The [W Hometown] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
61  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select a city.  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to change the  
region.  
Hometown  
(p.255) for cities that can be selected as a  
hometown.  
New York  
DST  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The cursor moves to [DST] (daylight saving time).  
7
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
8
Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the [Initial Setting] screen.  
9
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The cursor moves to [Text Size].  
10 Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Standard] or  
[Large].  
Initial Setting  
English  
New York  
Text Size  
Standard  
Large  
Selecting [Large] increases the text size  
of the selected menu items.  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
11 Press the 4 button.  
12 Press the four-way controller (3)  
Initial Setting  
to select [Settings complete].  
English  
New York  
Text Size  
Standard  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
62  
13 Press the 4 button.  
The [Date Adjustment] screen appears.  
You can change the text size from the [  
R
Set-up 1] menu later. In this manual,  
the menu screens hereafter are described with [Text Size] set to [Standard].  
• When the hometown and the date and time are not set, the [Initial Setting]  
screen or [Date Adjustment] screen will be displayed again next time the  
camera is turned on.  
2
Setting the Date and Time  
Set the current date and time and the display style.  
1
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The frame moves to [mm/dd/yy].  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to choose the date format.  
Date Adjustment  
Date Format  
Date  
mm/dd/yy  
24h  
Choose [mm/dd/yy], [dd/mm/yy] or [yy/  
mm/dd].  
01/01/2012  
Time  
:
00 00  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The frame moves to [24h].  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select 24h (24-hour display) or  
12h (12-hour display).  
Date Adjustment  
Date Format  
Date  
mm/dd/yy  
24h  
01/01/2012  
Time  
:
00 00  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
63  
5
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The frame returns to [Date Format].  
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The frame moves to [Date].  
Press the four-way controller (5).  
2
The frame moves to the month.  
8
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to set the month.  
Date Adjustment  
Date Format  
Date  
mm/dd/yy  
01/01/2012  
24h  
Set the day and year in the same manner.  
Next, set the time.  
Time  
:
00 00  
If you select [12h] in Step 4, the camera  
switches between am and pm depending  
on the time.  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
9
Press the four-way controller (3)  
to select [Settings complete].  
Date Adjustment  
Date Format  
Date  
mm/dd/yy  
24h  
10/10/2012  
Time  
:
00 00  
Settings complete  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
10 Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the status screen and is ready to take a picture.  
If you set the date and time from the menu, the screen will return to the  
[R Set-up 1] menu. In this case, press the 3 button.  
• When you press the 4 button in Step 10, the seconds value is set to 0. To  
set the exact time, press the 4 button when the time signal (on the TV,  
radio, etc.) reaches 0 seconds.  
• Pressing the 3 button while setting the date and time cancels the  
settings made up to that point and switches the camera to capture mode.  
• You can change the language and date and time settings from the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Basic Operations  
This chapter explains basic operations for shooting by  
setting mode dial to Green mode (automatic exposure  
according to the program line set to j) to ensure  
successful capturing.  
For information about advanced functions and settings for  
taking pictures, refer to chapter 4 and onward.  
Basic Shooting Operation ...................................66  
Using the Built-in Flash .......................................69  
Playing Back Images ............................................73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
66  
Basic Shooting Operation  
Letting the Camera Choose the Optimal Settings  
This camera features various exposure modes, focus modes, and drive  
modes for expressing your photographic vision. This section explains how  
to take pictures by simply pressing the shutter release button.  
3
1
Set the mode dial to B.  
Turn the mode dial while pressing the  
mode dial lock button.  
The exposure mode changes to B  
(Green) mode. In B mode, a proper  
exposure is determined by the camera  
and the shutter speed and aperture value  
are automatically set.  
Mode dial lock button  
2
Set the focus mode switch to  
l
.
The focus mode changes to l  
(Autofocus/Single) mode. When the  
shutter release button is pressed halfway  
in l, the camera focuses  
automatically. (p.108)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
67  
3
4
Look through the viewfinder to  
view the subject.  
A zoom lens can be used to change the  
size of the subject in the viewfinder. (p.68)  
Position the subject inside the AF frame and press the  
shutter release button halfway.  
3
The autofocus system operates.  
The focus indicator ] appears and you  
will hear a beep when the subject comes  
into focus (focus lock).  
The AF assist light turns on in a dark or  
backlit location, but the flash does not pop  
up automatically. If the flash is necessary,  
the flash status E blinks in the viewfinder.  
Press the E button to pop up the flash.  
Flash  
status  
Focus indicator  
5
6
Press the shutter release button fully.  
The picture is taken.  
This action is referred to as “releasing the shutter” or “release”.  
Review the captured image on the monitor.  
The image appears for 1 second on the monitor shortly after capturing  
(Instant Review).  
You can magnify the image during Instant Review with the rear e-dial  
(S). (p.211)  
You can delete the image during Instant Review by pressing the i  
button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
68  
• Refer to p.90 for details on using B (Green) mode.  
• The beep that sounds when the image is focused can be turned off. (p.252)  
• You can set the camera so that pressing the = button will focus  
automatically, in the same way as pressing the shutter release button  
halfway. (p.110)  
• You can preview the image on the monitor and check the composition,  
exposure, and focus before shooting. (p.118)  
Using a Zoom Lens  
3
Enlarge the subject (telephoto) or capture a wider area (wide angle) with  
a zoom lens. Adjust the subject to the desired size and take pictures.  
1
Turn the zoom ring to the right or  
left.  
Turn the zoom ring clockwise for  
telephoto and counterclockwise for wide  
angle.  
Power Zoom (Auto Zoom) is available if a Power Zoom compatible FA lens is  
used with this camera. (p.297)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
69  
Using the Built-in Flash  
Use the built-in flash when you want to take pictures in low light or backlit  
conditions.  
The built-in flash is optimum for a subject at a distance from 0.7 m to 5 m.  
Exposure will not be properly controlled and vignetting (darkening of the  
corners of the image due to a lack of light) may occur when used at a  
distance closer than 0.7 m (this distance varies slightly depending on the  
lens being used and set sensitivity. (p.165))  
3
Compatibility of built-in flash and lens  
Vignetting may occur depending on the lens being used and the  
shooting conditions. We recommend taking a test shot to check the  
compatibility.  
• When using the built-in flash, remove the lens hood before shooting.  
• The built-in flash fully discharges for lenses without an s (Auto)  
position on the lens aperture ring.  
For details on the built-in flash and instructions on how to take pictures with an  
external flash, refer to “Using the Flash” (p.161).  
Setting the Flash Mode  
Flash Mode  
Function  
Auto Flash  
Discharge  
Automatically measures the ambient light and  
determines whether to use the flash.  
C
Auto Flash+  
Red-eye Reduction the automatic flash.  
Discharges a pre-flash for red-eye reduction before  
D
E
Flash On  
Discharges the flash for each picture.  
Flash On+  
Red-eye Reduction the main flash.  
Discharges a pre-flash for red-eye reduction before  
F
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
70  
Flash Mode  
Function  
Sets to a slow shutter speed depending on the  
brightness. When using this to shoot a portrait with  
the sunset in the background, both the person and  
the background are captured beautifully.  
Slow-speed Sync  
G
H
Slow-speed Sync+ Discharges a pre-flash for red-eye reduction before  
Red-eye Reduction the main flash is discharged with Slow-speed Sync.  
Discharges the flash immediately before closing the  
shutter curtain. Captures moving objects as if they  
are leaving a light trail behind them. (p.164)  
Trailing Curtain  
Sync  
I
k
You can synchronize one or more dedicated external  
flashes (AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ) without using a  
sync cord. (p.170)  
3
Wireless Mode  
r
The flash modes that can be selected differ depending on the exposure mode.  
Exposure Mode  
Selectable Flash Mode  
C/D  
Restrictions  
B
No flash compensation  
e/c/K  
b/L/a/p  
M
E/F/G/H/I/r  
E/F/k/r  
-
-
-
E/F/r  
A
According to the saved settings  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Capture mode.  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
The flash modes that can be selected for the set exposure mode appear.  
2
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select a flash mode.  
Flash Mode  
Flash On  
When not in B (Green) mode, turn the  
rear e-dial (S) to perform the flash  
exposure compensation. (p.71)  
0.0  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
Compensating for Flash Output  
You can change the flash output in the range of -2.0 to +1.0. The flash  
compensation values are as follows for 1/3 EV and 1/2 EV.  
Step Interval  
1/3 EV  
Flash Compensation Value  
-2.0, -1.7, -1.3, -1.0, -0.7, -0.3, 0.0, +0.3, +0.7, +1.0  
-2.0, -1.5, -1.0, -0.5, 0.0, +0.5, +1.0  
1/2 EV  
Set interval of steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.106)  
3
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) in the  
[Flash Mode] screen.  
Flash Mode  
Flash On  
The flash compensation value is  
displayed.  
Press the | button to reset the flash  
+0.3  
output compensation value to 0.0.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
• The flash output compensation cannot be set in B (Green) mode.  
N appears in the viewfinder and on the LCD panel during the flash output  
compensation. (p.36, p.38)  
• When the flash output exceeds its maximum amount, the compensation will  
not be effective even if the compensation value is set to the plus (+) side.  
• Compensating to the minus (-) side may not affect the image if the subject is  
too close, the aperture value is small or the sensitivity is high.  
• The flash output compensation is also effective for external flash units which  
support the P-TTL auto flash mode.  
Enabling Shooting while Charging the Flash  
You can set the camera to enable  
20. Release While Charging  
shooting while the built-in flash is  
charging.  
1
2
Off  
On  
[On] in the [A Custom Setting 3] menu.  
By default, pictures cannot be taken  
while the built-in flash is charging.  
Enables shutter release  
while the built-in  
flash is charging  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
72  
Using Built-in Flash  
1
Press the E button.  
3
The built-in flash pops up and begins  
charging. When the flash is fully charged,  
E appears in the viewfinder and on the  
LCD panel. (p.36, p.38)  
2
3
Press the shutter release button fully.  
The picture is taken.  
When the mode dial is at B, the flash is not discharged if the lighting  
conditions do not require flash for correction even when the flash is  
popped up.  
[Flash On] is used if the flash is popped up when the mode dial is at a  
position other than B.  
Push down on the portion  
indicated in the illustration to  
retract the built-in flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
73  
Playing Back Images  
Playing Back Images  
You can play back captured images with the camera.  
1
Press the Q button.  
The camera enters Playback mode and  
the most recently captured image (image  
with the highest file number) is displayed  
on the monitor. (For movies, only the first  
frame is displayed on the monitor.)  
3
2
Review the captured image on the monitor.  
Available operations  
Four-way controller (4)/  
Displays the previous image.  
Front e-dial (R) to the left  
Four-way controller (5)/  
Displays the next image.  
Front e-dial (R) to the right  
M button  
Switches information display On/Off. (p.30)  
L button  
Saves the RAW image (only when the data  
is available).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
74  
• When the file format of the last captured image is JPEG, and its data still  
remains in the buffer memory, you can save the image in RAW format by  
pressing the L button during playback.  
If the image was shot using any of the following settings, the corresponding  
RAW image listed is saved.  
- Interval Shooting  
- Multi-exposure  
- Extended Bracketing  
- Digital Filter  
RAW image of the last captured image  
RAW image with Multi-exposure  
One out of the three images can be selected  
RAW image without filter effect  
- HDR Capture  
- Cross Processing  
RAW image with standard exposure  
RAW image without Cross Processing  
• Refer to “Playback Functions” (p.207) for details on the playback mode  
functions.  
3
Deleting a Single Image  
You can delete images one by one.  
• Deleted images cannot be restored.  
• Protected images cannot be deleted. (p.222)  
1
Press the Q button and use the four-way controller (45)  
to select an image to delete.  
2
Press the i button.  
The delete confirmation screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
75  
3
4
Press the four-way controller (2)  
to select [Delete].  
100-0105  
Select a file format to delete for images  
saved in RAW+ format.  
Delete  
Cancel  
Deletes only the JPEG  
Delete JPEG  
image.  
OK  
OK  
Deletes only the RAW  
Delete RAW  
image.  
Delete  
Deletes images in both  
3
RAW+JPEG file formats.  
Press the 4 button.  
The image is deleted.  
When deleting multiple images at once, refer to “Deleting Multiple Images”  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
76  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Shooting Functions  
This chapter describes the various basic and advanced  
shooting functions available with this camera.  
Setting the Exposure ...........................................83  
Focusing .............................................................108  
Before Shooting (Preview) ................................118  
Camera Shake .....................................................122  
Taking Pictures Continuously ...........................132  
(Auto Bracketing) ...............................................138  
Shooting with Live View ....................................146  
Recording Movies ..............................................152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
78  
How to Operate the Shooting  
Functions  
You can change capture-related settings using the direct keys, control  
panel, [A Rec. Mode] menu or [A Custom Setting] menu.  
For details on how to use the direct keys and menus, refer to “How to Change  
Direct Keys Setting Items  
Press the four-way controller (2345) in  
Capture mode to set the following items.  
4
Key  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Sets Continuous Shooting, Self-timer,  
Remote Control, Exposure Bracketing  
or Mirror Lock-up Shooting.  
Drive Mode  
2
Flash Mode  
Sets the method of flash discharge.  
3
4
Adjusts the color balance to match the  
type of the light source illuminating the  
subject.  
White Balance  
Sets the image finishing tone such as  
color and contrast before shooting an  
image.  
Custom Image  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
79  
Rec. Mode Menu Setting Items  
The following settings can be performed in  
the [A Rec. Mode 1-5] menus.  
Press the 3 button in Capture mode to  
display the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu.  
Menu  
Item  
Function  
Page  
USER Mode  
Switches between the saved  
A
modes. p.206  
4
Sets the exposure mode when the mode  
dial is set to A.  
Exposure Mode  
File Format  
Sets the file format.  
JPEG Recorded  
Sets the recording size of images saved  
in JPEG format.  
Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
Sets the quality of images saved in JPEG format. p.179  
AUTO AF Point  
Setting  
Sets the number of AF points when the  
A1  
focusing area is set to S (AUTO).  
Sets whether to continue to focus on your  
subject based on information from the  
focus points surrounding the selected  
focus point if your subject briefly moves out  
Expanded Area AF  
from the selected focus point when the AF  
point switching dial is set to  
j
(Select).  
Corrects distortions and chromatic  
aberrations occurring due to lens properties.  
Lens Correction  
Changes the hues and contrast by  
performing digital cross processing.  
Cross Processing  
Extended Bracketing  
Sets the Extended Bracketing shooting settings. p.141  
Applies a digital filter effect when taking pictures. p.143  
Enables capturing images with high dynamic range. p.191  
Digital Filter  
HDR Capture  
A2  
Creates a composite picture by taking  
multiple frames.  
Multi-exposure  
Interval Shooting  
Composition Adjust.  
Takes pictures at a set interval from a set time. p.133  
Adjusts the composition of your image  
using the Shake Reduction mechanism.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
80  
Menu  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Expands the dynamic range and prevents  
bright and dark areas from occurring.  
D-Range Setting  
Sets the range of automatic correction in  
ISO AUTO.  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Sets whether to use Noise Reduction  
when shooting with a high ISO sensitivity.  
A3  
Slow Shutter Speed  
NR  
Sets whether to use Noise Reduction in  
slow speed shooting.  
Program Line  
Color Space  
Selects Program Line.  
Sets the color space to use.  
Sets the file format of images saved in  
RAW format.  
RAW File Format  
4
Movie  
Sets the movie settings.  
Live View  
Sets the Live View settings.  
Sets whether to display the electronic level  
which detects whether the camera is level.  
Electronic Level  
Horizon Correction  
Shake Reduction *2  
Corrects the tilt (right and left) of the image. p.123  
Reduces vertical and horizontal camera  
A4  
shake.  
Sets the focal length when using a lens  
whose focal length information cannot be p.124  
obtained.  
Input Focal Length  
GPS  
Sets the functions for when the optional  
GPS unit is attached to the camera.  
Instant Review  
Digital Preview  
Sets the Instant Review display settings. p.259  
Sets the Digital Preview settings.  
Sets the functions assigned to the e-dials  
in each exposure mode.  
E-Dial Programming  
Sets the functions for when the |/Y  
button, = button, or Preview dial is  
operated, or the shutter release button is  
pressed halfway.  
A5  
Button Customization  
Determines which settings to save when  
the power is turned off.  
Memory  
Saves the current camera settings as  
A.  
Save USER Mode  
*1 Appears only when the mode dial is set to  
*2 Can also be set using the control panel.  
A.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
81  
Custom Setting Menu Setting Items  
Set the [A Custom Setting 1-4] menus to fully use the functions of a SLR  
camera.  
Menu  
Item  
1. EV Steps  
Function  
Page  
Sets the adjustment steps for exposure. p.106  
Sets the adjustment steps for ISO  
sensitivity.  
2. Sensitivity Steps  
3. Expanded  
Sensitivity  
Expands the lower and upper sensitivity  
limits.  
4. Meter Operating  
Time  
Sets the exposure metering time.  
4
A1  
5. AE-L with AF  
Locked  
Sets whether to lock the exposure value  
when the focus is locked.  
Sets whether to link the exposure and  
6. Link AE to AF Point AF point in the focusing area during  
multi-segment metering.  
Sets whether to automatically  
7. Auto EV  
compensate when the proper exposure  
Compensation  
-
cannot be determined.  
8. Auto Bracketing  
Order  
Sets the order for Auto Bracketing  
shooting.  
Sets whether to shoot all frames with  
one press of the shutter release button p.140  
when using Exposure Bracketing.  
9. One-Push  
Bracketing  
Sets whether to automatically fine-tune  
10. WB Adjustable  
Range  
the white balance when specifying the  
light source on the white balance  
setting.  
A2  
11. WB When Using  
Flash  
Sets the white balance setting when  
using flash.  
Sets whether to adjust the tungsten light  
color tone when the white balance is set  
to F (Auto White Balance).  
12. AWB in Tungsten  
Light  
-
13. Color Temperature Sets the adjustment steps for color  
Steps  
temperature.  
14. Superimpose AF  
Area  
Sets whether to display the active AF  
point(s) in red in the viewfinder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
82  
Menu  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Sets the action priority for when the  
focus mode is set to l and the  
shutter release button is fully pressed.  
15. AF.S Setting  
Sets the action priority for Continuous  
16. AF.C Setting  
Shooting when the focus mode is set to p.109  
k.  
Sets whether to use the AF assist light  
17. AF Assist Light  
when autofocusing in dark locations.  
A3 18. AF with Remote  
Sets whether to use autofocus when  
Control  
shooting with remote control.  
Sets the remote control operation when  
using the remote control in p (Bulb  
Exposure) mode.  
19. Remote Control in  
Bulb  
4
20. Release While  
Charging  
Sets whether to release shutter while  
the built-in flash is charging.  
21. Flash in Wireless Sets the built-in flash discharge method  
Mode  
in wireless mode.  
22. LCD Panel  
Illumination  
Sets the illumination for the LCD panel. p.38  
23. Saving Rotation  
Info  
Sets whether to save rotation  
information when shooting.  
Sets whether to save the last menu tab  
24. Save Menu  
Location  
displayed on the monitor and to display  
it again the next time the 3 button  
is pressed.  
When set to [On], if the focus mode is  
set to l and a manual focus lens is  
A4  
attached, Catch-in Focus shooting is  
enabled and the shutter is released  
25. Catch-in Focus  
automatically when the subject comes  
into focus.  
26. AF Fine  
Adjustment  
Adjusts the AF focusing position.  
Sets whether to enable shutter release  
when the lens aperture ring is set to the p.299  
position other than s.  
27. Using Aperture  
Ring  
Reset Custom  
Functions  
Resets all the settings in the [A Custom  
Setting 1-4] menus to the defaults.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
83  
Setting the Exposure  
Setting the Sensitivity  
You can set the sensitivity to suit the brightness of the surroundings.  
The sensitivity can be set to [ISO AUTO] or within a sensitivity range  
equivalent to ISO 100 to 12800. The default setting is [ISO AUTO].  
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) while  
pressing the o button in  
Capture mode.  
4
The sensitivity displayed on the status  
screen and LCD panel and in the  
viewfinder changes.  
Press the | button to set the sensitivity to  
[ISO AUTO].  
AF.S  
P
1/200  
F
5.0  
ISO  
AUTO  
200  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
ISO AUTO  
16M  
2
Take your finger off the o button and rear e-dial (S).  
The sensitivity is set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
84  
• The sensitivity can also be changed by pressing the o button once, taking  
your finger off the button and turning the rear e-dial (S). In this case, the  
sensitivity is fixed when the o button is pressed again or the exposure  
metering timer (p.104) elapses.  
• When the exposure mode is set to B (Green), L (Shutter & Aperture  
Priority Automatic Exposure) or C (Movie), the sensitivity is fixed to [ISO  
AUTO] and the setting cannot be changed.  
• When the exposure mode is set to K (Sensitivity Priority Automatic  
Exposure), a (Manual Exposure), p (Bulb Exposure) or M (Flash X-sync  
Speed), the sensitivity cannot be set to [ISO AUTO].  
The sensitivity range can be expanded to a range of ISO 80 to 51200 when  
[3. Expanded Sensitivity] in the [ Custom Setting 1] menu is set to [On].  
However, the minimum sensitivity is ISO 160 when [Highlight Correction] is  
set to [On] in [D-Range Setting] (p.190) of the [ Rec. Mode 3] menu.  
Captured images may show more noise if a higher sensitivity is set. You can  
reduce image noise by setting [High-ISO NR] in the [ Rec. Mode 3] menu. (p.85)  
A
A
A
4
You can select whether to set the sensitivity in increments of 1 EV or in  
accordance with the EV step setting for exposure (p.106). This can be set in  
A
Custom Setting 1] menu.  
Setting the Range of Automatic Sensitivity Correction  
Set the range in which the sensitivity is automatically adjusted when the  
sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO]. The sensitivity is automatically corrected  
in the range of [ISO 100-3200] by default.  
1
Select [ISO AUTO Setting] in the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [ISO AUTO Setting] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
ISO AUTO Setting  
ISOAUTO  
100  
-
3200  
(23) to set the minimum  
sensitivity.  
AUTO ISO Parameters  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the four-way controller (5) and use the four-way  
controller (23) to set the maximum sensitivity.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
85  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [AUTO ISO  
Parameters] and press the four-way controller (5).  
6
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the parameter and press  
ISO AUTO Setting  
ISOAUTO  
100  
-
3200  
the 4 button.  
AUTO ISO Parameters  
Increases the sensitivity  
as little as possible  
Slow  
u
s
a
Standard (default setting)  
Actively increases the  
sensitivity  
MENU  
4
Fast  
7
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Reducing Image Noise (Noise Reduction)  
When shooting with a digital camera, image noise (image roughness or  
unevenness) becomes noticeable in the following situations.  
- when shooting with a long exposure  
- when shooting with a high sensitivity setting  
- when the temperature of the CMOS sensor is high  
You can reduce image noise by using Noise Reduction. However, images  
shot with Noise Reduction will take longer to save.  
High-ISO NR  
Reduces noise at high sensitivity (ISO) settings.  
1
Select [High-ISO NR] in the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [High-ISO NR] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
86  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Auto], [Off],  
[Low], [Medium], [High] or  
[Custom].  
High-ISO NR  
ISO  
NRAUTO  
Auto  
OFF  
Off  
NR  
ISO  
ISO  
Low  
NR  
ISO  
Medium  
NR  
ISO  
High  
Custom  
NR  
ISO  
NRCUSTOM  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Applies Noise Reduction at optimally calculated levels  
throughout ISO range. (default setting)  
Auto  
Off  
Does not apply Noise Reduction at any ISO setting.  
Low/Medium/ Applies Noise Reduction at constant chosen level  
High  
throughout ISO range.  
4
Custom  
Applies Noise Reduction at user-defined levels for each ISO setting.  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
If you select [Auto], [Off], [Low], [Medium], or [High], proceed to Step 7.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Setting] and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The screen to set the noise reduction level according to the sensitivity appears.  
5
Use the four-way controller (23)  
1
2
High-ISO NR  
80  
ISO  
NR  
to select a sensitivity value and use  
the four-way controller (45) to set  
the level of noise reduction which is  
applied to the selected sensitivity.  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to display the  
[High-ISO NR 2] screen.  
OFF  
ISO  
ISO  
NR  
ISO  
NR  
ISO  
NR  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ISO 100  
ISO 200  
ISO 400  
ISO 800  
ISO 1600  
ISO 3200  
ISO  
NR  
ISO  
NR  
ISO  
NR  
MENU  
Reset  
Press the | button to reset the setting of  
the selected sensitivity value.  
The sensitivity values displayed vary according to the [1. EV Steps] and [2.  
Sensitivity Steps] settings made in the [  
A
Custom Setting 1] menu.  
6
7
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 2 appears again.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
87  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Reduces noise during long exposures.  
1
Select [Slow Shutter Speed NR] in the [A Rec. Mode 3]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Auto], [On] or [Off], and  
press the 4 button.  
1
2
4
3
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
ISO  
NR  
AUTO  
AUTO  
ON  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
Color Space  
NR  
NR  
NR  
OFF  
4
RAW File Format  
PEF  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Determines conditions such as shutter speed, sensitivity, and  
internal temperature, and automatically applies Noise  
Reduction as necessary. (default setting)  
Auto  
Applies Noise Reduction when the exposure time is longer than 1  
second.  
On  
Off  
Does not apply Noise Reduction.  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• Processing may take a while when shooting with Slow Shutter Speed NR set  
to [On]. Pictures cannot be taken while an image is being processed.  
• When the Noise Reduction function is activated, [nr] blinks on the LCD panel  
and in the viewfinder where the aperture value is normally displayed, and a  
countdown of processing time is displayed where the shutter speed is  
normally displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
88  
Changing the Exposure Mode  
This camera features the following exposure modes. Use the mode dial to  
change the exposure mode. (p.45)  
The settings available for each exposure mode are as follows.  
(z: Available ×: Not available)  
Change Change  
Shutter Aperture  
EV  
Compen-  
sation  
Change  
Exposure Mode  
Page  
Sensitivity  
Speed  
Value  
B
Green  
×
×
×
×
e
z
z
z
z
Program Automatic Exposure  
4
K
Sensitivity Priority Automatic  
Exposure  
Other than  
ISO AUTO  
×
×
z
z
z
z
b
Shutter Priority Automatic  
Exposure  
z
×
×
z
z
c
Aperture Priority Automatic  
Exposure  
z
z
L
Shutter & Aperture Priority  
Automatic Exposure  
ISO AUTO  
only  
z
a
Other than  
ISO AUTO  
z
×
z
z
z
×
Manual Exposure  
p
Other than  
ISO AUTO  
Bulb Exposure  
M
Flash X-sync Speed  
Other than  
ISO AUTO  
×
For each exposure mode, you can set the functions for when the front/rear  
e-dial or the | button is operated. Set in [E-Dial Programming] of the [A Rec.  
Mode 5] menu. (p.247) You can confirm the functions of the front and rear  
e-dials and the | button by viewing the guides which appear on the monitor  
when the camera is switched on or the mode dial is turned. (p.25)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
89  
Program Line  
In [Program Line] of the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu, you can choose from  
the following Program Lines. When [eLINE] is selected for the |  
button setting in e/K mode or L/a mode (p.247), exposure is  
regulated according to the set Program Line.  
Setting  
j Auto  
Characteristics  
Camera determines the appropriate settings.  
Basic Program Automatic Exposure (default  
setting)  
k Normal  
Program Automatic Exposure that prioritizes high  
shutter speeds.  
l Hi-speed Priority  
4
Program Automatic Exposure that closes the  
aperture as much as possible for a deep depth of  
field.  
DOF Priority  
m
(deep)  
Program Automatic Exposure that opens the  
aperture as much as possible for a shallow depth  
of field.  
DOF Priority  
n
(shallow)  
Program Automatic Exposure that prioritizes the  
best aperture settings for the attached lens when  
a DA, DA L, D FA, FA J or FA lens is used.  
o MTF Priority  
Using a Lens with an Aperture Ring  
When using a lens with an aperture  
ring, set the aperture to the s (AUTO)  
position while holding down the auto-  
lock button on the lens.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
90  
Using the B Mode  
Lets you capture images with fully automatic settings.  
In B mode, pictures are taken with the following settings.  
• Program Line  
• File Format  
• Sensitivity  
j (AUTO)  
JPEG  
ISO AUTO  
• Metering Method  
• AF Point  
L (Multi-segment Metering)  
S (Auto)  
• AUTO AF Point Setting 11 AF Points  
• White Balance  
• Custom Image  
• High-ISO NR  
F (Auto)  
Bright  
Auto  
4
• Slow Shutter Speed NR On  
• Shake Reduction  
• Color Space  
k (On)  
sRGB  
If the 3 button is pressed in B mode, the menu for Green Mode appears.  
You cannot select items that cannot be changed.  
1
Set the mode dial to B.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
91  
• In B mode, the following functions and operations are not available.  
• Changing the shutter speed  
• Changing the aperture value  
• EV Compensation  
• Multi-exposure  
• Interval Shooting  
• Extended Bracketing  
• Digital Filter  
• Flash (Flash On, Slow-speed  
Sync, Trailing Curtain Sync,  
Wireless Mode, Exposure  
Compensation)  
• Continuous Shooting  
• Focus Mode k (l is  
selected)  
• HDR Capture  
• Cross Processing  
• Horizon Correction  
• Saving as A mode  
L and |/Y button  
operations  
• D-Range Setting  
• Lens Correction  
• Button Customization (default  
settings are used)  
• Exposure Bracketing  
• Mirror Lock-up Shooting  
• Custom menu settings (default  
settings are used)  
4
• The control panel cannot be displayed in B mode.  
Using the e Mode  
Automatically sets the shutter speed and aperture value to obtain a proper  
exposure according to the selected Program Line when taking pictures.  
You can also use the front and rear e-dials to change the shutter speed or  
aperture value while maintaining the proper exposure. (p.247)  
1
Set the mode dial to e.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
92  
2
Check the shutter speed and aperture value.  
Check the settings using the status screen, viewfinder or LCD panel.  
AF.S  
P
1/125  
F
5.6  
ISO  
AUTO  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
Set the Program Line to use in [Program Line] of the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu.  
4
Using the K Mode  
You can set the sensitivity to suit the brightness of the subject.  
The shutter speed and aperture value are automatically set according to  
the selected sensitivity to obtain a proper exposure.  
1
Set the mode dial to K.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
93  
2
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to  
adjust the sensitivity.  
The set values are displayed in the status screen and viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel.  
AF.S  
Sv  
1/30  
F
4.5  
4
ISO  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
• You can set the sensitivity to a value equivalent to ISO 100 to 12800. [ISO  
AUTO] is not available.  
The sensitivity can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV. Set the exposure  
steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [ Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.106)  
A
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
94  
Using the b Mode  
Lets you set the desired shutter speed for expressing moving subjects.  
When taking pictures of a fast moving subject, you can increase the  
shutter speed to make the subject look still or decrease the shutter speed  
to have the subject show movement.  
The aperture value is automatically set to give a proper exposure  
depending on the shutter speed.  
1
Set the mode dial to b.  
4
2
Turn the front e-dial (R) to  
adjust the shutter speed.  
The shutter speed can be set within the  
range of 1/8000 to 30 seconds.  
The set values are displayed in the status screen and viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel.  
AF.S  
Tv  
1/125  
F
5.6  
ISO  
AUTO  
400  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
95  
• The shutter speed can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV. Set the  
exposure steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.106)  
• The proper exposure may not be obtained with the selected shutter speed  
when the sensitivity is not set to [ISO AUTO] (p.83).  
Exposure Warning  
If the subject is too bright or too dark,  
the aperture value will blink on the  
status screen and LCD panel and in  
the viewfinder. If the subject is too bright, choose a faster shutter  
speed. If it is too dark, choose a slower shutter speed. When the  
aperture value indication stops blinking, you can take a picture with  
proper exposure.  
4
Use a commercially available ND (Neutral Density) Filter if the subject  
is too bright. Use a flash if it is too dark.  
Using the c Mode  
Set the aperture value for controlling the depth of field. The depth of field  
is deeper and the front and back of the focused object is clear when the  
aperture is set to a large value, small lens opening. The depth of field is  
shallower and the front and back of the focused object is blurred when the  
aperture is set to a small value, large lens opening.  
The shutter speed is automatically set to the proper exposure depending  
on the aperture value.  
1
Set the mode dial to c.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
96  
2
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to  
adjust the aperture value.  
The set values are displayed in the status screen and viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel.  
AF.S  
Av  
1/30  
F
4.5  
4
ISO  
AUTO  
400  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
• The aperture value can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV. Set the  
exposure steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.106)  
• The proper exposure may not be obtained with the selected aperture value  
when the sensitivity is not set to [ISO AUTO] (p.83).  
Exposure Warning  
If the subject is too bright or too dark,  
the shutter speed will blink on the status  
screen and LCD panel and in the  
viewfinder. When the subject is too bright, set the aperture to a  
smaller lens opening (larger number), and when too dark, set the  
aperture to a larger lens opening (smaller number). Once blinking  
stops, you can take a picture with proper exposure.  
Use a commercially available ND (Neutral Density) Filter if the subject  
is too bright. Use a flash if it is too dark.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
97  
Using the L Mode  
You can set both the desired shutter speed and aperture to take the  
picture.  
Automatically sets the sensitivity so that the manually set shutter speed  
and aperture value will give the proper exposure according to the  
brightness of the subject.  
1
Set the mode dial to L.  
4
2
3
Turn the front e-dial (R) to  
adjust the shutter speed.  
The shutter speed can be set within the  
range of 1/8000 to 30 seconds.  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to  
adjust the aperture value.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
98  
The set values are displayed in the status screen and viewfinder and on  
the LCD panel.  
AF.S  
TAv  
1/1000  
F
4.5  
ISO  
AUTO  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
• The shutter speed and aperture value can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or  
1/2 EV. Set the exposure steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1]  
menu. (p.106)  
• In L mode, the sensitivity is fixed to [ISO AUTO].  
4
Exposure Warning  
If the subject is too bright or too dark,  
the sensitivity will blink on the status  
screen and LCD panel and in the  
viewfinder. In such situations, change the shutter speed and  
aperture. When the indication stops blinking, you can take a picture  
with proper exposure.  
Use a commercially available ND (Neutral Density) Filter if the subject  
is too bright. Use a flash if it is too dark.  
Using the a Mode  
You can set the shutter speed and aperture value. This mode is suitable  
to take pictures of your choice by combining them. This mode is  
convenient for taking pictures using the same combination of the shutter  
speed and aperture settings or taking intentionally underexposed (darker)  
or overexposed (brighter) photographs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
99  
1
Set the mode dial to a.  
2
3
Turn the front e-dial (R) to  
adjust the shutter speed.  
The shutter speed can be set within the  
range of 1/8000 to 30 seconds.  
4
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to  
adjust the aperture value.  
The set values are displayed in the status  
screen and viewfinder and on the LCD  
panel.  
AF.S  
M
1/125  
F
5.6  
ISO  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
100  
While adjusting the shutter speed or  
aperture value, the difference from the  
proper exposure (EV value) is displayed  
in a bar graph. The proper exposure is set  
when V is in the middle of the EV bar. If it  
is towards -, it is underexposed. If it is  
towards +, it is overexposed. If the value  
exceeds the range of the EV bar, or if the  
subject is too bright or too dark, the “+” or “-” blinks.  
Difference from the  
proper exposure  
• The sensitivity cannot be set to [ISO AUTO] in a mode. If the exposure mode  
is changed to a mode when the sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO], the  
sensitivity is also changed to the lowest value set in “Setting the Range of  
• The shutter speed and aperture value can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or  
1/2 EV. Set the exposure steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1]  
menu. (p.106)  
4
• Since the bar graphs in the viewfinder and  
on the LCD panel display the amount of  
camera tilt to the left or right, the  
difference from the proper exposure is  
displayed as a number when [Electronic Level] is set to O (On).  
Combining with L  
When the exposure is locked (p.107) by pressing the L button in  
a mode, if the shutter speed or aperture value is changed, the  
combination of shutter speed and aperture value changes while the  
exposure value is retained.  
Example:If the shutter speed is 1/125 sec. and aperture is F5.6 and  
these settings are locked with the L button, the  
aperture automatically changes to F11 if the shutter speed  
is changed to 1/30 sec. with the front e-dial (R).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
101  
Using the p Mode  
This setting is useful when shooting night scenes and fireworks which  
require long exposures.  
1
Set the mode dial to p.  
4
AF.S  
B
Bulb  
ISO  
F
5.6  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
2
3
Press the shutter release button.  
The shutter remains open as long as the shutter release button is kept  
pressed.  
Take your finger off the shutter release button.  
Exposure ends.  
The following functions are not available in p mode.  
- EV Compensation  
- Exposure Bracketing  
- Continuous Shooting  
- Interval Shooting  
- HDR Capture  
- AE Lock  
- Shake Reduction  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
102  
• The aperture value can be set in increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV. Set the  
exposure steps in [1. EV Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.106)  
Use a sturdy tripod and the cable switch CS-205 (optional) or Remote Control  
(optional) to prevent camera shake when using  
switch to the cable release terminal (p.20).  
p
mode. Connect the cable  
• When using the remote control, set whether to start exposure with a press  
and stop it with another press of the shutter release button on the remote  
control, or to keep the shutter open as long as the release button on the  
remote control is kept pressed. Set in [19. Remote Control in Bulb] of the  
[A Custom Setting 3] menu.  
• The sensitivity cannot be set to [ISO AUTO] in p mode. If the exposure mode  
is changed to p mode when the sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO], the  
sensitivity is also changed to the lowest value set in “Setting the Range of  
• There is no limit on exposure time for Bulb shooting. However, we  
recommend the use of the AC adapter kit (optional) when shooting with a  
long exposure setting as the battery is being drained while the shutter  
remains open. (p.52)  
4
Using the M Mode  
The shutter speed is locked at 1/180 second. Use this when using an  
external flash that does not automatically set the sync speed.  
1
Set the mode dial to M.  
AF.S  
X
1/180  
F
5.6  
ISO  
100  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
[
]
37  
16M  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
103  
• Turn the rear e-dial (S) to adjust the aperture value.  
• Press the | button to retain the shutter speed at 1/180 second and  
automatically adjust the aperture value.  
• The sensitivity cannot be set to [ISO AUTO] in M mode. If the exposure  
mode is changed to M mode when the sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO], the  
sensitivity is also changed to the lowest value set in “Setting the Range of  
Selecting the Metering Method  
Choose the part of the viewfinder to use for measuring brightness and  
determining exposure. The following three methods are available. The  
factory default setting is L (Multi-segment metering).  
4
1
Turn the metering mode switch.  
The set metering method is displayed in  
the status screen and viewfinder.  
 L Multi-segmented Metering  
The scene in the viewfinder is metered in  
77 different zones. Even in backlit  
locations, this mode automatically  
determines what level of brightness is in  
which portion and automatically adjusts  
exposure.  
 M Center-weighted Metering  
Metering is weighted at the center of the  
viewfinder. Use this metering when you  
want to compensate for the exposure by  
experience, instead of leaving it to the  
camera. The illustration shows that  
sensitivity increases as the pattern height  
increases (center). This mode does not  
automatically compensate for backlit scenes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
104  
 N Spot Metering  
The brightness is measured only within a  
limited area at the center of the  
viewfinder. You can use this in  
combination with the AE Lock (p.107)  
when the subject is extremely small and  
the correct exposure is difficult to obtain.  
Center-weighted metering mode is automatically set even if you select multi-  
segment metering mode when using a lens other than a DA, DA L, D FA, FA J,  
FA, F or A lens, or when the lens aperture ring is set to a position other than s  
(Auto). (Can only be used if [27. Using Aperture Ring] (p.299) in the [A Custom  
Setting 4] menu is set to [Permitted].)  
4
Linking AE to AF Point during Multi-segment  
Metering  
In [6. Link AE to AF Point] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu, you can  
link the exposure and AF point in the focusing area during multi-  
segment metering.  
Off Exposure is set separately from the AF point. (default setting)  
On Exposure is set in accordance with the AF point.  
1
2
Setting the Meter Operating Time  
You can set the exposure metering time to [10 sec.] (default setting),  
[3 sec.] or [30 sec.] in [4. Meter Operating Time] of the [A Custom  
Setting 1] menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
105  
Adjusting Exposure  
This allows you to deliberately overexpose (brighten) or underexpose  
(darken) your picture.  
The exposure steps can be selected from 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV in [1. EV Steps]  
of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. You can adjust the EV compensation  
value from -5 to +5 (EV).  
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) while  
pressing the m button.  
The exposure is adjusted.  
4
m is displayed in the status screen and viewfinder and on the LCD panel  
during adjustment.  
AF.S  
P
1/100  
F
4.0  
Compensation value  
ISO  
AUTO  
800  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
11  
AWB  
JPEG  
0EV  
16M  
Press the | button to reset the EV compensation value to 0.0.  
Press the m button to check the compensation value after adjustment.  
EV compensation is not available when the exposure mode is set to  
B (Green) or p (Bulb Exposure) mode.  
• The compensation value can also be changed by pressing the m button  
once, taking your finger off the button and turning the rear e-dial (S). In  
this case, EV compensation is set when the m button is pressed again or the  
exposure metering timer (p.104) elapses.  
• The compensation value is not canceled by turning the camera off or by  
switching to another exposure mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
106  
EV Compensation for a and M modes  
For example, if the EV compensation value is set to +1.5 for a  
(Manual Exposure) and M (Flash X-sync speed) modes, an  
underexposure of 1.5 EV is displayed on the EV bar. If you set the  
exposure value so that the V is displayed at the center of the EV bar,  
the image will be captured with the compensated value.  
Changing the Exposure Steps  
4
Set the exposure compensation steps to  
1. EV Steps  
increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV in [1. EV  
Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu.  
1
2
1/3 EV Steps  
1/2 EV Steps  
Exposure compensation steps  
now set to 1/3 EV  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Step Interval  
1/3 EV  
Exposure Setting Value  
±0.3, ±0.7, ±1.0, ±1.3, ±1.7, ±2.0, ±2.3, ±2.7, ±3.0, ±3.3, ±3.7,  
±4.0, ±4.3, ±4.7, ±5.0  
±0.5, ±1.0, ±1.5, ±2.0, ±2.5, ±3.0, ±3.5, ±4.0, ±4.5, ±5.0  
1/2 EV  
Changing the Exposure Automatically when Shooting  
Auto Bracketing is a function for continuously shooting images with  
the exposure automatically adjusted for underexposure and  
overexposure. Each time the shutter release button is pressed, 2, 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
107  
Locking the Exposure Before Shooting (AE Lock)  
AE Lock is a function that locks the exposure prior to taking a picture. Use  
this when the subject is too small to obtain a proper exposure or is backlit.  
1
Set the exposure and press the  
L button.  
The camera locks the exposure  
(brightness) at that instant.  
@ is displayed in the status screen and  
viewfinder while the AE Lock is engaged.  
4
• The exposure remains locked as long as the L button is kept pressed or  
the shutter release button is kept pressed halfway. The exposure remains  
locked for twice the amount of the exposure metering timer (p.104) even after  
taking your finger off the L button.  
• You will hear a beep when the L button is pressed. The beep can be  
turned off. (p.252)  
• AE Lock is not available in B (Green), p (Bulb Exposure) or M (Flash X-  
sync Speed) mode.  
• When any of the following operations are performed, AE Lock is canceled.  
- the L button is pressed again  
- the Q button, 3 button or M button is pressed  
- the mode dial is turned  
- the lens is changed  
- a lens with an s (Auto) position is set to a position other than the s position  
• The combination of shutter speed and aperture value changes depending on  
the zooming position even while the AE Lock is engaged when using a zoom  
lens whose maximum aperture value varies depending on the focal length.  
However, the exposure value does not change and a picture is taken at a  
brightness level set when the AE Lock is activated.  
• The exposure can also be locked when the focus is locked. Set in [5. AE-L  
with AF Locked] of the [A Custom Setting 1] menu. (p.115)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
108  
Focusing  
You can focus with the following methods.  
The camera automatically focuses on the subject when the  
shutter release button is pressed halfway.  
Autofocus  
=
Manual focus  
Manually adjust the focus. (p.116)  
\
Using the Autofocus  
You can also choose the autofocus mode from l (Single mode) where  
the shutter release button is pressed halfway to focus on the subject and  
the focus is locked at that position, and k (Continuous mode) where  
the subject is kept in focus by continuous adjustment while the shutter  
release button is pressed halfway. The factory default setting is l.  
4
1
Set the focus mode switch to l  
or A.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
109  
When the shutter release button is pressed halfway and the  
subject comes into focus, the focus is locked (focus lock) at  
that position. If the subject is outside the focusing area, focus  
the camera on the subject in the focusing area, lock the focus  
at that position (focus lock), and then recompose your picture.  
• The AF assist light turns on as necessary. (p.109)  
• Set the action priority for when the shutter release button is  
pressed fully in [15. AF.S Setting] of the [A Custom Setting 3]  
menu.  
l
Single  
mode  
The shutter cannot be released until the  
subject is in focus. (default setting)  
Focus-  
priority  
If the subject is too close to the camera, move  
back and take the picture. If the subject is difficult  
to focus, adjust the focus manually. (p.116)  
1
Release- The shutter can be released even if the  
priority subject is not in focus.  
2
4
The subject is kept in focus by continuous adjustment while the  
shutter release button is pressed halfway. The focus indicator  
] appears and you will hear a beep when the subject comes  
into focus. Even if the subject is not in focus, the shutter can be  
released when the shutter release button is pressed fully.  
• When the shutter release button is pressed halfway to focus,  
the camera automatically tracks the subject if it is determined  
to be a moving object. The lens will automatically operate and  
continuously focus on the subject.  
k (A)  
Continuous  
mode  
• Set the action priority for Continuous Shooting in [16. AF.C  
Setting] of the [A Custom Setting 3] menu.  
Takes pictures giving priority to keeping the  
Focus-  
priority  
subject in focus during Continuous Shooting.  
(default setting)  
1
2
FPS-  
Takes pictures giving priority to the shooting  
priority speed during Continuous Shooting.  
AF Assist Light  
You can set whether or not to use the AF assist light during  
in [17. AF Assist Light] of the [ Custom Setting 3] menu.  
l
mode  
A
To make focusing easier when the subject is in a dark location,  
On the AF assist light turns on when the shutter release button is  
pressed halfway. (default setting)  
1
2
Off The AF assist light will not be used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
110  
Using the = Button to Focus on the Subject  
You can set the camera so that focusing is performed when the = button  
is pressed.  
1
Select [Button Customization] in the [A Rec. Mode 5]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Button Customization] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [AF Button]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [AF Button] screen appears.  
4
Press the four-way controller (5)  
AF Button  
and use the four-way controller  
Enable AF  
Cancel AF  
(23) to select [Enable AF].  
AF is performed when  
the AF button is pressed  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Autofocus is performed by using the = button or the  
shutter release button. (default setting)  
Enable AF  
Cancel AF  
\ appears in the viewfinder while the = button is  
pressed. Autofocus is not performed when the shutter  
release button is pressed. (Take your finger off the =  
button to return to normal autofocus mode.)  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button three times.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
111  
6
Press the = button while  
looking through the viewfinder.  
Autofocus is performed.  
When the = button is pressed and the subject comes  
into focus, the Focus Lock function is activated while  
the button is pressed.  
l
Single mode  
k
The subject is kept in focus while the = button is  
Continuous mode pressed.  
4
7
Press the shutter release button.  
When [Enable AF] is assigned to [Shutter Button Half Press] in [Button  
Customization], press the shutter release button while holding down the  
= button.  
The picture is taken.  
AF Fine Adjustment  
You can adjust the AF focusing position.  
• Be sure to use [AF Fine Adjustment] only when necessary. Care should  
be taken as adjusting the autofocus may make it difficult to capture  
images with the appropriate focus. Set to [Off] if you do not need to  
adjust the AF focusing position.  
Any camera shake during test shooting may make it difficult to obtain the  
accurate focusing position. Therefore, always use a tripod when taking test shots.  
1
Select [26. AF Fine Adjustment] in the [A Custom Setting  
4] menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [On] and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
112  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Apply All] or  
[Apply One].  
Apply All Applies the same adjustment value to all lenses.  
Apply  
One  
This item will appear on the display only when the lens ID is obtained. Saves and  
applies a different adjustment value for each lens type. (Up to 20 lens types)  
Reset  
Resets the saved adjustment value.  
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and adjust the value.  
26. AF Fine Adjustment  
Apply All  
+5  
Apply One  
Unset  
4
Reset  
OK  
MENU  
0
Cancel  
OK  
Available operations  
Four-way controller (5)/  
Rear e-dial (S) to the right (y)  
Adjusts the focus to a closer position.  
Adjusts the focus to a farther position.  
Resets the adjustment value to ±0.  
Four-way controller (4)/  
Rear e-dial (S) to the left (f)  
| button  
5
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The adjustment value is saved.  
Press the 3 button three times.  
The camera returns to Capture mode.  
Take a test picture.  
You can easily check the focusing point by enlarging the image during  
Digital Preview (p.120) or Live View (p.146).  
Even when an adjustment value has been saved using [Apply One], if you  
press the 4 button with [Apply All] selected in Step 3, the [Apply All] value is  
used instead of the [Apply One] value.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
113  
Selecting the Focusing Area (AF Point)  
Choose the part of the viewfinder to set focus to. The factory default  
setting is S (Auto).  
Selected AF point(s) light red in the viewfinder (Superimpose AF Area).  
Center  
Select  
Sets the focusing area to the center of the viewfinder.  
U
Sets the focusing area to the user selected point from eleven  
points in the AF frame.  
j
The camera selects the optimum AF point even if the subject  
is not centered. You can select from 11 AF points (default  
setting) or 5 points in [AUTO AF Point Setting] of [AF Settings]  
in the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu.  
Auto  
S
4
1
Turn the AF point switching dial.  
• AF point(s) are not illuminated red in the viewfinder when [Off] is selected for  
[14. Superimpose AF Area] in the [A Custom Setting 2] menu.  
• The focusing area is fixed to U regardless of this setting when using lenses  
other than DA, DA L, D FA, FA J, FA or F lens. (p.297)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
114  
Setting the Focus Position in the Viewfinder  
1
Set the AF point switching dial to  
j.  
V appears in the viewfinder and the AF  
point can be changed.  
2
3
Look through the viewfinder and check the position of the  
subject.  
4
Use the four-way controller (2345) to change the AF  
point.  
The selected AF point appears in the  
status screen.  
AF.S  
P
1/2000  
F
2.8  
ISO  
AUTO 1600  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
AWB  
[
]
JPEG 16M  
37  
Available operations  
4 button  
Returns the AF point to the center of the AF frame.  
Press and hold  
4 button  
Disables changing the AF point and enables direct key  
operation of the four-way controller (2345). To  
enable changing the AF point, press the 4 button  
while direct key operation is enabled. You will hear a  
beep when switching between enabled and disabled.  
The AF point(s) light red in the viewfinder (Superimpose AF Area) and  
you can check where you set the AF point.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
115  
• The position of the changed AF point is stored even if the camera is turned  
off or the focusing area is switched to U or S.  
V appears in the viewfinder when the AF point can be changed.  
• When [Expanded Area AF] is set to O (On) in [AF Settings] of the [A Rec.  
Mode 1] menu, if your subject briefly moves out from the focus point that was  
selected when the focus mode was set to k, the camera will continue to  
focus on your subject based on information from the focus points (back-up  
focus points) surrounding the selected focus point. The back-up focus points  
are displayed in pink on the status screen.  
Locking Exposure when the Focus is Locked  
Set [5. AE-L with AF Locked] in the  
5. AE-L with AF Locked  
[A Custom Setting 1] menu to lock the  
exposure value while the focus is  
locked.  
1
2
Off  
On  
4
AE is locked  
when the focus  
is locked  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Off Exposure is not locked when the focus is locked. (default setting)  
On Exposure is locked when the focus is locked.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
116  
Adjusting the Focus Manually (Manual Focus)  
When you adjust the focus manually, you can use either the focus  
indicator or the matte field in the viewfinder.  
Using the Focus Indicator  
The focus indicator ] appears in the viewfinder when the subject is in  
focus even during manual focus.  
You can manually adjust the focus using the focus indicator ].  
1
Set the focus mode switch to \.  
4
2
Look through the viewfinder,  
press the shutter release button  
halfway and turn the focusing  
ring.  
The focus indicator ] appears and you  
will hear a beep when the subject comes  
into focus.  
• Adjust the focus manually using the matte field in the viewfinder when the  
subject is difficult to focus and the focus indicator does not appear.  
• The beep that sounds when the image is focused can be turned off. (p.252)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
117  
Using the Viewfinder Matte Field  
You can manually adjust the focus using the matte field in viewfinder.  
1
Set the focus mode switch to  
\.  
2
Look through the viewfinder and turn the focusing ring  
until the subject is clearly visible in the viewfinder.  
Shooting in Catch-in Focus Mode  
When [25. Catch-in Focus] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu is set to  
[On], if the focus mode is set to l and one of the following types  
of lenses is attached, Catch-in Focus shooting is enabled and the  
shutter is released automatically when the subject comes into focus.  
• Manual focus lens  
4
• DA or FA lens that enables switching = and \ modes on the  
lens itself (the setting on the lens must be set to \ before  
shooting)  
 How to Take Pictures  
1 Attach a proper lens to the camera.  
2 Set the focus mode switch to l.  
3 Set the focus on a position the subject will pass.  
4 Press the shutter release button fully.  
The shutter is released automatically when the subject comes  
into focus at the set position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
118  
Checking the Composition, Exposure  
and Focus Before Shooting (Preview)  
You can use the preview function to check depth of field, composition,  
exposure and focus before taking a picture.  
There are two preview methods.  
Preview Method  
Optical Preview  
Description  
For checking the depth of field with the viewfinder.  
|
For checking the composition, exposure and  
focus on the monitor.  
Digital Preview  
e
You can use the Live View function that displays a real-time image on the  
monitor and enables you to change the shooting settings and magnify the  
image. (p.146)  
4
Selecting the Preview Method  
Choose whether to use Optical Preview or Digital Preview when the main  
switch is turned to the preview position (|).  
The default setting is Optical Preview.  
1
Select [Button Customization] in the [A Rec. Mode 5]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Button Customization] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Preview Dial]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Preview Dial] screen appears.  
Press the four-way controller (5)  
Preview Dial  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Optical Preview]  
Optical Preview  
Digital Preview  
or [Digital Preview].  
For checking depth of  
field with viewfinder  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
119  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button three times.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• While shooting with Mirror Lock-up Shooting, Interval Shooting, Multi-  
exposure or Live View, Optical Preview is used regardless of the setting.  
• Digital Preview can also be assigned to the |/Y button. If Optical  
Preview is assigned to the Preview dial and Digital Preview is assigned to the  
|/Y button, you can use both preview functions easily. Refer to p.249  
for assigning a function to the |/Y button.  
4
Setting the Display for Digital Preview  
For Digital Preview, you can set whether to display the histogram and  
Bright/Dark Area warning, and whether to enable enlarging images.  
1
Select [Digital Preview] in the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Digital Preview] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Histogram],  
[Bright/Dark Area] or [Enlarge  
Digital Preview  
Histogram  
Bright/Dark Area  
Enlarge Instant Review  
Instant Review].  
MENU  
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
3
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
120  
Displaying the Optical Preview  
1
Focus on the subject.  
2
Turn the main switch to | while  
looking through the viewfinder.  
You can check the depth of field in the  
viewfinder while the main switch is set to  
the position |.  
During this time, no shooting information  
is displayed in the viewfinder, and the  
shutter cannot be released.  
4
3
Take your finger off the main switch.  
Optical Preview is ended and the camera is ready to take a picture.  
Displaying the Digital Preview  
1
Focus on the subject and compose the picture in the  
viewfinder.  
2
Turn the main switch to |.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
121  
When Digital Preview is assigned to the  
|/Y button, press the |/Y  
button.  
The icon (|) appears on the monitor  
during preview and you can check the  
composition, exposure and focus.  
4
AE.L  
Available operations  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Enlarges the preview image. (p.211)  
Saves the preview image.  
L button  
3
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
Digital Preview is ended and the autofocus system operates.  
The maximum display time for Digital Preview is 60 seconds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
122  
Using the Shake Reduction Function  
to Prevent Camera Shake  
Using the Shake Reduction Function  
The Shake Reduction function reduces camera shake that occurs when  
the shutter release button is pressed.  
Ideal when taking pictures in the following situations.  
• When taking pictures in dimly lit locations, such as indoors, at night,  
on cloudy days and in the shade  
• When taking telephoto pictures  
The Shake Reduction function can be used to reduce horizontal and  
vertical camera shake or keep the image level.  
4
The Shake Reduction function does not compensate for blurring caused by subject  
movement. To take pictures of a moving subject, increase the shutter speed.  
• The Shake Reduction function may not fully reduce camera shake when  
taking close-up shots. In this case, it is recommended to turn off the Shake  
Reduction function and use the camera with a tripod.  
• The Shake Reduction function will not fully work when shooting with a very  
slow shutter speed, for example when panning or shooting night scenes. In  
this case, it is recommended to turn off the Shake Reduction function and use  
the camera with a tripod.  
The Shake Reduction function is available with any PENTAX lens compatible  
with this camera. However, be sure to set the focal length before using a lens  
for which focal length information cannot be automatically obtained. Refer to  
Reducing Vertical and Horizontal Camera Shake  
1
Select [Shake Reduction] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select k or l and press  
the 4 button.  
1
2
3
4 5  
Movie  
Live View  
Electronic Level  
Horizon Correction  
Shake Reduction  
Input Focal Length  
GPS  
Uses Shake Reduction. (default  
setting)  
k
l Does not use Shake Reduction.  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
123  
3
4
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
k appears in the viewfinder and the  
Shake Reduction function is activated.  
• Set [Shake Reduction] to l (Off) when using the camera with a tripod or  
when this function is not needed.  
• The Shake Reduction function automatically turns off in the following  
situations. Note that the Shake Reduction function cannot be selected when  
the following functions are set.  
- p (Bulb Exposure) mode  
- Self-timer shooting  
4
- Remote Control shooting  
- Mirror Lock-up shooting  
- when [Auto Align] is set to P (Off) in the [HDR Capture] setting  
- when using the flash in wireless mode  
Correcting the Tilt of the Images  
1
Select [Horizon Correction] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(45) to select O or P.  
1
2
3
4 5  
Movie  
Live View  
Electronic Level  
Horizon Correction  
Shake Reduction  
Input Focal Length  
GPS  
35mm  
MENU Exit  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
124  
4
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The following indicators appear on the status screen.  
k Shake Reduction On + Horizon Correction Off  
l Shake Reduction Off + Horizon Correction Off  
q Shake Reduction On + Horizon Correction On  
r
Shake Reduction Off + Horizon Correction On  
• The Shake Reduction function will not fully work (for about 2 seconds) right  
after turning on the camera or restoring from Auto Power Off. Wait for the  
Shake Reduction function to become stable, and then press the shutter  
button gently. If k appears in the viewfinder when you press the shutter  
release button halfway, the camera is ready to take a picture.  
• The Shake Reduction function is available with any PENTAX lens compatible  
with this camera. However, when the aperture ring is set to a position other  
than the s (Auto) position for a lens with a s position or a lens without an s  
position is used, the camera will not operate unless [27. Using Aperture Ring]  
is set to [Permitted] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu. Set this beforehand.  
In such cases, however, some functions will be restricted. Refer to “Using the  
4
When the Focal Length Cannot Be Automatically Detected  
The Shake Reduction function operates by obtaining the lens information  
such as focal length.  
If the camera uses a DA, DA L, D FA, FA J, FA or F lens, the lens information  
is automatically obtained when the Shake Reduction function is activated.  
Set the focal length if you use a lens whose information such as focal  
length cannot be automatically obtained (p.297).  
• The [Input Focal Length] setting screen does not appear when using a lens  
whose information such as focal length can be automatically obtained.  
• When using a lens without the s position on the aperture or with the aperture  
set to a position other than s, set [27. Using Aperture Ring] in the [A Custom  
Setting 4] menu to [Permitted]. (p.299)  
• The effect of Shake Reduction is influenced by the shooting distance as well  
as focal length information. The Shake Reduction function may not work as  
effectively as expected when shooting at close ranges.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
125  
1
Make sure that [Shake Reduction] is set to k (On) and  
turn the camera off.  
details.  
2
3
Attach a lens and turn the camera on.  
The [Input Focal Length] screen appears.  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to set  
Input Focal Length  
the focal length.  
Select from the following focal length  
values. (The default setting is 35 mm.)  
100  
135  
4
120  
8
10 12 15 18 20 24 28 30 35  
40 45 50 55 65 70 75 85 100 120  
135 150 180 200 250 300 350 400 450 500  
550 600 700 800  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
• If the focal length for your lens is not listed above, select the value closest to  
the actual focal length (example: [18] for 17 mm and [100] for 105 mm).  
• When using a zoom lens, select the actual focal length at the zoom setting  
being used.  
4
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
To change the focal length setting, use [Input Focal Length] in the [A Rec.  
Mode 4] menu.  
Shooting with Self-timer  
Self-timer  
(12 sec.)  
Shutter is released after about 12 seconds. Use this mode to  
include the photographer in the picture.  
g
A mirror pops up immediately after the shutter release button is  
pressed. The shutter is released after about 2 seconds. Use this mode  
to avoid camera shake when the shutter release button is pressed.  
Self-timer  
(2 sec.)  
Z
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
126  
1
Mount the camera onto a tripod.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) in Capture mode.  
The [Drive Mode] screen appears.  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (45) to select g.  
Press the four-way controller (3)  
Drive Mode  
and use the four-way controller  
Self-timer (12 sec.)  
(45) to select g or Z.  
MUP  
2
s
4
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
5
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
Press the shutter release button  
fully.  
For g, the front and back self-timer lamps  
start blinking slowly and blink rapidly 2  
seconds before the shutter is released.  
The beep is heard and the rate increases.  
The shutter will be released about 12  
seconds after the shutter release button  
is pressed fully.  
For Z, the shutter will be released about  
2 seconds after the shutter release button  
is pressed fully.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
127  
• Select a mode other than g or Z in the [Drive Mode] screen to cancel the  
Self-timer shooting. The setting is canceled when the camera is turned off if  
[Drive Mode] is set to P (Off) in [Memory] of the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu.  
(p.274)  
• The Shake Reduction function is automatically turned off when g or Z is set.  
• You can set the camera so that the beep does not sound. (p.252)  
• The exposure may be affected if light enters the viewfinder. Use the AE Lock  
function (p.107) or attach the provided ME viewfinder cap. The light entering  
the viewfinder has no effect on the exposure when the exposure mode is set  
to a (Manual Exposure).  
4
Removing the Eyecup FR  
Attaching the ME Viewfinder cap  
Shooting with Remote Control (Optional)  
The shutter can be released from a distance by using the optional remote  
control unit.  
The shutter is released immediately after the shutter  
release button on the remote control unit is pressed.  
Remote Control  
h
i
RemoteControl The shutter is released about 3 seconds after the shutter  
(3s delay)  
release button on the remote control unit is pressed.  
Continuous shooting starts when the shutter release  
button on the remote control unit is pressed. Press the  
shutter release button on the remote control unit again to  
exit continuous shooting.  
Remote  
Continuous  
Shooting  
i
1
Mount the camera onto a tripod.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) in Capture mode.  
The [Drive Mode] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
128  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (45) to select h.  
Press the four-way controller (3)  
Drive Mode  
Remote Control  
and use the four-way controller  
MUP  
(45) to select h, i, or i.  
W appears on the LCD panel. The self-  
timer lamp will blink and the camera is in  
a stand-by status.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
5
6
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
4
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
7
Point the remote control unit  
towards the remote control  
receiver on the front or back of  
the camera and press the shutter  
release button on the remote  
control.  
Approx.  
4 m  
The operating distance of the remote  
control unit is approximately 4 m from the  
front of the camera and approximately 2  
m from the back of the camera.  
Approx.  
2 m  
After a picture is taken, the self-timer  
lamp lights for 2 seconds and then returns  
to blinking.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
129  
• By default, you cannot adjust the focus with the remote control unit. Focus on  
the subject first with the camera before operating with the remote control.  
When [18. AF with Remote Control] is set to [On] in the [A Custom Setting 3]  
menu, you can use the remote control unit to adjust the focus. (AF cannot be  
used with the remote control unit during Live View.)  
• Select a mode other than h, i or i in the [Drive Mode] screen to cancel  
the Remote Control shooting. The setting is canceled when the camera is  
turned off if [Drive Mode] is set to P (Off) in [Memory] of the [A Rec. Mode  
5] menu. (p.274)  
• The Shake Reduction function is automatically turned off when h, i or i  
is set.  
• The exposure may be affected if light enters the viewfinder. Use the AE Lock  
function (p.107) or attach the provided ME viewfinder cap. The light entering  
the viewfinder has no effect on the exposure when the exposure mode is set  
to a (Manual Exposure).  
4
Removing the Eyecup FR  
Attaching the  
ME Viewfinder cap  
• The remote control may not operate in backlit conditions.  
• When using the Remote Control Waterproof O-RC1, AF can be operated with  
the S button. The { button cannot be used.  
• The Remote Control F can send a remote control signal about 30,000 times.  
Contact a PENTAX Service Center to replace the battery (this will involve a  
fee).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
130  
Shooting with the Mirror Lock-up Function  
Use the Mirror Lock-up function if camera shake is evident even when the  
remote control or cable switch is used with a tripod.  
For Mirror Lock-up Shooting, press the shutter release button to raise the  
mirror up and press it again to release the shutter.  
Mirror Up  
Mirror Lock-up shooting with the shutter release button.  
d
e
Mirror Lock-up shooting with the remote control. The  
shutter will be released immediately after the shutter  
Mirror Up +  
Remote Control release button on the remote control unit is pressed  
(p.127).  
4
1
Mount the camera onto a tripod.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) in Capture mode.  
The [Drive Mode] screen appears.  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (45) to select d.  
Press the four-way controller (3)  
Drive Mode  
Mirror Lock-up Shooting  
and use the four-way controller  
MUP  
(45) to select d or e.  
MUP  
d appears in the status screen and on  
the LCD panel.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
5
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
Press the shutter release button fully.  
The mirror pops up and you will hear a beep. The AE Lock function is  
enabled with the exposure value set immediately before the mirror pops up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
131  
8
Press the shutter release button fully again.  
The shutter is released and the picture is taken.  
• Select a mode other than d or e in the [Drive Mode] screen to cancel  
Mirror Lock-up shooting. The setting is canceled when the camera is turned  
off if [Drive Mode] is set to P (Off) in [Memory] of the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu.  
(p.274)  
• The mirror automatically returns to its original position if 1 minute elapses  
after the mirror pops up when the shutter release button is pressed for the  
first time (except while using Multi-exposure).  
• The Shake Reduction function is automatically turned off when d or e  
is set.  
• The beep that sounds when the mirror pops up can be turned off. (p.252)  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
132  
Taking Pictures Continuously  
Continuous Shooting  
Pictures can be taken continuously while the shutter release button is kept  
pressed.  
Continuous  
For JPEG image with p/C, up to approx. 30 frames  
g
h
Shooting (Hi) are taken continuously at a maximum of approx. 7.0 fps.  
For JPEG image with p/C, pictures are taken  
continuously at a maximum of approx. 1.6 fps until the SD  
Memory Card is full.  
Continuous  
Shooting (Lo)  
4
When the file format is [RAW] (PEF), up to approx. 20 frames for g and up to  
approx. 40 frames for h can be taken continuously.  
1
Press the four-way controller (2) in Capture mode.  
The [Drive Mode] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (45) to select g.  
Press the four-way controller (3)  
Drive Mode  
Continuous Shooting (Hi)  
and use the four-way controller  
MUP  
(45) to select g or h.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
133  
6
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Pictures are taken continuously while the shutter release button is fully  
pressed. Take your finger off the shutter release button to stop.  
• If the focus mode is set to l (Single mode), the focus position is locked in  
the first frame and pictures are taken continuously at the same interval.  
• Focusing is continuously activated during Continuous Shooting when the focus  
mode is set to k (Continuous mode).  
• You can also use the remote control for Continuous Shooting. (p.127)  
• The shutter cannot be released until charging is complete when using the  
built-in flash. You can set the camera to enable shutter release before the  
built-in flash is ready in [20. Release While Charging] of the [A Custom  
Setting 3] menu. (p.71)  
• Select a mode other than g or h in the [Drive Mode] screen to cancel the  
Continuous Shooting. The setting is canceled when the camera is turned off  
if [Drive Mode] is set to P (Off) in [Memory] of the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu.  
(p.274)  
4
• The shooting speed may be slower when [Lens Correction] (p.193) is set to  
On.  
Interval Shooting  
During Interval Shooting, pictures are taken at a set interval from a set  
time.  
• Interval Shooting is not available in the following situations.  
- when the exposure mode is set to B (Green), p (Bulb Exposure), A,  
or C (Movie)  
- when Extended Bracketing, Digital Filter or HDR Capture is set  
• When Interval Shooting is set, Multi-exposure is not available.  
1
Select [Interval Shooting] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Interval Shooting] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
134  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Interval].  
Interval Shooting  
Start Shooting  
:
Interval  
00 00 ' 00"  
002images  
Now  
When taking two or more pictures, set the  
wait time until the next picture is taken.  
Number of Shots  
Start Interval  
Start Time  
Use the four-way controller (45) to  
select the number of hours, minutes, and  
seconds, and use the four-way controller  
(23) to set the time.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
You can set up to 24 hours, 00 minutes, and 00 seconds.  
Press the 4 button to complete the setting.  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Number of  
Shots].  
4
Set the number of shots to be taken.  
Press the four-way controller (5) and use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the number of shots to be taken.  
You can select between 1 and 999 shots.  
Press the 4 button to complete the setting.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Start Interval].  
Set the time when the first picture is taken.  
Press the four-way controller (5) and use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Now] or [Set Time].  
Shooting starts immediately. You can take two or more  
pictures.  
Now  
Shooting starts at the set time. Press the four-way controller  
(3) to select [Start Time], use the four-way controller (45) to  
select the time, and use the four-way controller (23) to set  
Set Time  
the start time.  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Start  
Shooting] and press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a series of interval pictures.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The focus during Interval Shooting is locked at this position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
135  
7
Press the shutter release button fully.  
When [Start Interval] is set to [Now], the first picture is taken. When set  
to [Set Time], shooting starts at the set time.  
For shooting multiple pictures, pictures are taken at the interval set in  
Step 2.  
To cancel shooting, press the 3 button.  
After the set number of pictures are taken, [Interval shooting complete] is  
displayed, and the camera returns to normal standby mode.  
• If the mode dial or the main switch is turned while shooting, the pictures that  
have been already taken are saved and Interval Shooting is ended.  
• [Single Frame Shooting] is selected regardless of the current drive mode  
setting.  
4
• If the subject is not in focus with the focus mode set to l (Single mode)  
or if the [Interval] setting is too short and the previous image processing  
cannot be completed before taking the next picture, no picture may be taken.  
• Although each shot taken is displayed with Instant Review, they cannot be  
magnified, deleted, or saved in RAW format.  
• Interval Shooting is canceled when the SD Memory Card has no more  
available space.  
• If the Auto Power Off function turns the camera off during Interval Shooting,  
the camera automatically turns on again when the shooting time approaches.  
• It is recommended to use the AC adapter kit (optional) when using the  
Interval Shooting over a long period of time. (p.52)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
136  
Multi-exposure  
You can create a composite picture by taking multiple frames.  
• Multi-exposure is not available in the following situations.  
- when the exposure mode is set to B (Green) or C (Movie)  
- when Extended Bracketing, Digital Filter, HDR Capture or Cross  
Processing is set  
• When Multi-exposure is set, the following functions are not available.  
-
Exposure Bracketing or Interval Shooting (The function selected last is used)  
- Lens Correction  
1
Select [Multi-exposure] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
4
The [Multi-exposure] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Number of  
Shots].  
Press the four-way controller (5)  
Multi-exposure  
and use the four-way controller  
Start Shooting  
(23) to select the number of  
Number of Shots  
2times  
Auto EV Adjustment  
shots.  
Select from 2 to 9 shots.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Auto EV  
Adjustment] and use the four-way controller (45) to  
select O or P.  
When set to O (On), the exposure is adjusted automatically according to  
the number of shots.  
6
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Start  
Shooting] and press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
137  
7
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
8
Press the shutter release button fully.  
The composite picture is displayed in Instant Review each time the  
shutter release button is pressed. Press the i button during Instant  
Review to discard pictures taken up to that point and take pictures again  
from the first frame.  
The pictures are saved when the set number of shots are taken, and then  
the [Multi-exposure] screen appears again.  
• If any of the following operations are performed while shooting, the pictures  
that have been already taken are saved and Multi-exposure is ended.  
4
- when the Q button, 3 button, four-way controller (2345), M  
button or |/Y button is pressed  
- when the mode dial is turned  
• When shooting in Multi-exposure mode using Live View, a semi-transparent  
composite image of the pictures taken is displayed. (It is not displayed when  
the camera is connected to an AV device.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
138  
Shooting while Adjusting the  
Settings (Auto Bracketing)  
Auto Bracketing is a function for shooting while automatically changing the  
camera settings. There are two Auto Bracketing modes: Exposure  
Bracketing and Extended Bracketing.  
You can set Auto Bracketing Order in [8. Auto Bracketing Order] in the  
[A Custom Setting 2] menu.  
1
2
3
4
0 - +  
- 0 +  
+ 0 -  
0 + -  
Standard ´ Underexposed ´ Overexposed (default setting)  
Underexposed ´ Standard ´ Overexposed  
Overexposed ´ Standard ´ Underexposed  
Standard ´ Overexposed ´ Underexposed  
4
Shooting while the Exposure is Automatically  
Changed (Exposure Bracketing)  
You can take continuous pictures with different exposures when the  
shutter release button is pressed. You can select to take 2 images  
(Standard/+), 2 images (Standard/-), 3 images or 5 images. When taking  
3 pictures, the first image is exposed with no compensation, the second  
image is underexposed (negative compensation) and the third image is  
overexposed (positive compensation).  
Standard exposure  
Underexposure  
Overexposure  
• Exposure Bracketing is not available in the following situations.  
- when the exposure mode is set to p (Bulb Exposure)  
- when HDR Capture is set  
• Exposure Bracketing and Multi-exposure cannot be used at the same time.  
The function selected last is used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
139  
1
Press the four-way controller (2) in Capture mode.  
The [Drive Mode] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (45) to select l.  
Press the four-way controller (3)  
Drive Mode  
Exposure Bracketing  
and use the four-way controller  
MUP  
(45) to select l, b, or c.  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4+5  
0.5EV  
3image(s)  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
Exposure  
Bracketing  
l
Takes pictures with the shutter release button.  
Exposure  
Bracketing +  
Self-timer  
Takes pictures with the self-timer. Self-timer  
operates according to the self-timer (p.125)  
setting.  
b
Takes pictures with the remote control. Remote  
control operates according to the remote control  
(p.127) setting. When set to i (Remote  
Continuous Shooting), the shutter is released  
immediately.  
Exposure  
Bracketing +  
Remote Control  
c
4
5
Turn the front e-dial (R) to set the number of shots.  
Select [2 images (+)], [2 images (-)], [3 image(s)] or [5 image(s)].  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to set the bracketing amount.  
The following values can be set according to the step interval set in [1.  
EV Steps] (p.106) in the [A Custom Setting 1] menu.  
Step Interval  
1/3 EV  
Bracketing Amount  
±0.3, ±0.7, ±1.0, ±1.3, ±1.7, ±2.0  
±0.5, ±1.0, ±1.5, ±2.0  
1/2 EV  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
140  
Available operations  
m button +  
Rear e-dial (  
Adjusts the EV compensation when taking only  
underexposed or overexposed images with Exposure  
Bracketing. Images are taken with an EV compensation  
value set to 0 (intermediate value). (Up to ±8 EV)  
)
S
| button  
Resets the compensation value to ±0.  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
When the subject is in focus, the focus indicator ] appears in the  
viewfinder and the EV compensation value appears on the status screen  
and LCD panel and in the viewfinder.  
4
8
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Continue to press the shutter release button until the set number of shots  
are captured.  
Consecutive images will be taken according to the order set in [8. Auto  
Bracketing Order] of the [A Custom Setting 2] menu.  
• When the focus mode is set to l (Single mode), the focus position is  
locked in the first image and is used for subsequent images.  
• When you take your finger off the shutter release button during Exposure  
Bracketing, the exposure setting will remain effective for twice the amount of  
the exposure metering timer (default setting is about 20 seconds) (p.104) and  
you can take a picture at the next compensation value. In this case,  
autofocus works for each image. After about twice the amount of the  
exposure metering timer elapses, the camera returns to settings for taking  
the first image.  
• When [9. One-Push Bracketing] in the [A Custom Setting 2] menu is set to  
[On], even if the shutter release button is not continuously pressed fully, all  
images are automatically shot with one press of the shutter release button.  
• You can combine Exposure Bracketing with the built-in flash or an external  
flash (P-TTL auto only) to change only the flash output continuously.  
However, when using an external flash, holding the shutter release button  
down to take consecutive images may cause the second and third images to  
be taken before the flash is fully charged. Take each image after confirming  
that charging is complete.  
Select a mode other than  
Exposure Bracketing. The setting is canceled when the camera is turned off if  
[Drive Mode] is set to (Off) in [Memory] of the [ Rec. Mode 5] menu. (p.274)  
l
,
b
or  
c
in the [Drive Mode] screen to cancel the  
P
A
• If you use Exposure Bracketing frequently, you can assign it to the |/Y  
button. (p.249)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
141  
Shooting while Adjusting Other Settings  
(Extended Bracketing)  
You can save pictures with three different levels of White Balance,  
Saturation, Hue, High/Low Key Adjustment, Contrast and Sharpness.  
Unlike Exposure Bracketing, three pictures are saved each time the  
shutter is released.  
• When Extended Bracketing is set, the file format is always set to [JPEG] and  
cannot be changed. You cannot use Extended Bracketing when the file  
format is set to [RAW] or [RAW+].  
• When Extended Bracketing is set, the following functions are not available.  
• Interval Shooting or Multi-exposure  
4
• Cross Processing, Digital Filter or HDR Capture (The function selected last  
is used)  
1
Select [Extended Bracketing] in the [A Rec. Mode 2]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Extended Bracketing] screen appears.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select an item and press the  
4 button.  
Extended Bracketing  
OFF  
Off  
WB  
White Balance  
Saturation  
Hue  
High/Low Key Adj  
Contrast  
S
Sharpness  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Bracketing  
Amount] and press the four-way controller (5).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
142  
5
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the bracketing amount  
and press the 4 button.  
Extended Bracketing  
Saturation  
1
2
3
4
Bracketing Amount  
Select [±1] (default setting), [±2], [±3] or  
[±4].  
For [White Balance], select from [BA±1]  
(default setting), [BA±2], [BA±3], [GM±1],  
[GM±2] or [GM±3].  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
6
7
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera returns to Capture mode.  
4
Press the shutter release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
8
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Three images are saved.  
• Exposure Bracketing and Extended Bracketing can be used at the same  
time. When used at the same time, each time the shutter is released for  
Exposure Bracketing, three images with Extended Bracketing applied are  
saved.  
• Parameters that cannot be set due to the image finishing tone setting of  
Custom Image also cannot be set for Extended Bracketing. (Example: When  
set to [Monochrome], Saturation and Hue cannot be selected for Extended  
Bracketing) (p.197)  
• When [Fine Sharpness] or [Extra Sharpness] is set for Custom Image, the  
sharpness of Extended Bracketing operates as Fine Sharpness or Extra  
Sharpness.  
• When [Contrast] is set for Custom Image, the contrast of Extended  
Bracketing operates according to the [Contrast] setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
143  
Taking Pictures Using Digital Filters  
You can apply a filter when taking pictures.  
The following filters can be selected.  
Filter Name  
Toy Camera  
Effect  
Parameter  
Shading Level: Low/Medium/High  
For taking pictures that  
look as if taken with a toy Blur: Low/Medium/High  
camera.  
Tone Break: Red/Green/Blue/Yellow  
Toning (B-A): 7 levels  
For taking pictures with  
the look of old photos.  
Retro  
Frame Composite: None/Thin/  
Medium/Thick  
4
For taking pictures with  
high contrasts.  
High Contrast  
+1 to +5  
Extracted Color 1: Red/Magenta/  
Blue/Cyan/Green/Yellow  
For extracting one or two  
specific colors and  
Extractable Range of Color 1: +1 to +5  
Extract Color  
making the rest of the  
image black and white.  
Extracted Color 2: OFF/Red/  
Magenta/Blue/Cyan/Green/Yellow  
Extractable Range of Color 2: +1 to +5  
For taking pictures with a Soft Focus: Low/Medium/High  
soft focus throughout the  
Soft  
Shadow Blur: OFF/ON  
image.  
Shape: Cross/Star/Snow Crystal/  
Heart/Musical Note  
For taking pictures of  
night scenes or lights  
reflected on water with a  
special sparkling look by  
adding extra glitter to the  
highlights.  
Effect Density: Small/Medium/Large  
Starburst  
Size: Small/Medium/Large  
Angle: 0°/30°/45°/60°  
For taking pictures that  
look as if taken with a  
fish-eye lens.  
Fish-eye  
Low/Medium/High  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
144  
Filter Name  
Effect  
Parameter  
High Contrast: OFF/+1 to +5  
Soft Focus: OFF/+1 to +3  
Tone Break: OFF/Red/Green/Blue/  
Yellow  
You can customize and  
save a filter to your own  
preferences.  
Shading Type: 6 types  
Shading Level: -3 to +3  
Distortion Type: 3 types  
Custom Filter  
Distortion Level: OFF/Low/Medium/  
High  
Invert Color: OFF/ON  
Color: Red/Magenta/Blue/Cyan/  
Green/Yellow  
For taking pictures with  
the selected color filter.  
4
Color  
Color Density: Light/Standard/Dark  
*1 Not available when the exposure mode is set to C (Movie).  
*2 Available only when the exposure mode is set to C (Movie).  
• When Digital Filter is set, the file format is always set to [JPEG] and cannot  
be changed. You cannot use Digital Filter when the file format is set to [RAW]  
or [RAW+].  
• When Digital Filter is set, the following functions are not available.  
- Interval Shooting, Multi-exposure, Continuous Shooting  
- Extended Bracketing or HDR Capture (The function selected last is used)  
Depending on the filter used, it may take longer to save images.  
1
Select [Digital Filter] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The screen for selecting a filter appears.  
The last image taken after the camera was turned on is displayed in the  
background.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
145  
2
3
Use the four-way controller  
(45) to select a filter.  
OFF  
Starburst  
AE.L  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select the parameter and  
the four-way controller (45) to  
adjust the parameter’s value.  
Shape  
4
AE.L  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Available operations  
Main switch (|)  
Uses Digital Preview to preview the background  
image with the filter effect applied. (Not available  
when the exposure mode is set to C (Movie).)  
L button  
Saves the background image.  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu.  
Press the 3 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• When the exposure mode is set to C (Movie), change the settings from  
[Movie] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu. (p.152)  
• Select [Not use any filters] in Step 2 to finish shooting with digital filter.  
• JPEG and RAW images can be processed with digital filters in Playback  
mode. (p.233)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
146  
Shooting with Live View  
You can shoot a picture while displaying the real-time image on the  
monitor.  
• The image in Live View may differ from the captured image if the brightness  
of the subject is low or high.  
• If any changes occur in the shooting light source during Live View, the image  
may flicker.  
• If the camera position is changed rapidly during Live View, the image may not  
be displayed with the appropriate brightness. Wait for the display to become  
stable before shooting.  
• Noise may appear on the Live View image when used in dark locations.  
• The higher the sensitivity, the more noise and color unevenness may occur in  
the Live View image and/or captured image.  
4
• Live View can be displayed for up to 5 minutes. When Live View is ended  
after the elapse of 5 minutes, Live View can be restarted by pressing the U  
button.  
• If you continue shooting with Live View for a prolonged period, the internal  
temperature of the camera may increase, resulting in lower quality images. It  
is recommended that you turn off Live View when not shooting. To prevent  
the image quality from degrading, allow enough time for the camera to cool  
down while shooting with long exposures or recording movies.  
• If the internal temperature of the camera becomes high, l (temperature  
warning) is displayed and Live View may not be available. If this happens,  
stop shooting or use the viewfinder.  
• During Live View, nothing is displayed in the viewfinder.  
• Holding the camera by hand and shooting while viewing the monitor may  
cause camera shake. Use of a tripod is recommended.  
• The field of view of the image display is nearly 100%.  
• You can use the provided AV cable or a commercially available HDMI cable  
to display the Live View image on a TV or monitor. (p.224)  
• Live View is not displayed when data is being saved to the SD Memory Card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
147  
Setting Live View  
You can set the display and autofocus mode for Live View.  
1
Select [Live View] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Live View] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select an autofocus  
Live View  
Autofocus Method  
Show Grid  
Info Overlay  
4
method.  
Histogram  
Bright/Dark Area  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Gives autofocus priority to detected faces and performs  
contrast autofocus. A yellow frame appears for a main  
face (white frames appear for other faces), and  
autofocus and automatic exposure are performed for  
the main face. (default setting)  
I
Face Detection  
AF  
The face detection is not performed when the focus  
mode is set to \.  
i
Contrast AF  
Displays Live View and performs autofocus based on  
the information obtained from the image sensor.  
Cancels Live View and performs autofocus with the AF  
sensor.  
If the shutter release button is pressed halfway during  
Live View, the Live View image will disappear and the  
autofocus system operates. Once focused, the Live  
View image will be displayed again.  
S
Phase Difference  
AF  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Show Grid]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
148  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a grid display type and  
press the 4 button.  
Live View  
Autofocus Method  
Show Grid  
Info Overlay  
OFF  
Histogram  
Bright/Dark Area  
Select from [Off] (default setting), e  
(4x4 Grid), f (Golden Section) or g  
(Scale).  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Info Overlay],  
[Histogram] or [Bright/Dark Area].  
7
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
4
8
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
It takes more time to focus on the subject when using I or i than when  
using S. It is also difficult for the camera to focus on the following objects (or  
under the following conditions).  
- objects with poor contrast  
- objects with no vertical contrast, such as horizontal stripes  
- objects with constantly changing brightness, shape, or color, such as a  
water fountain  
- objects whose distance from the camera changes  
- small objects  
- objects appearing in both the foreground and background  
- when using a special filter  
- objects at the edge of the screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
149  
Taking a Still Picture  
1
Select an exposure mode.  
Set the mode dial to any mode other than C.  
2
Press the U button.  
The mirror pops up and a real-time image  
is displayed on the monitor. Press the U  
button again to exit Live View.  
4
Live View display  
(All of the indicators are displayed here for explanatory purposes.)  
1
2 3 4 5 6 7  
8
USER  
P
P
SHIFT  
12  
9
10  
13  
14  
15  
16  
+1.0  
11  
-
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4 +5  
2000 F2.8 ISO3200  
1234  
2000 F2.8 ISO400  
[
]
[
]
37  
17 18 1920 21  
22  
23  
24  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Exposure Mode  
Flash Mode  
Drive Mode  
White Balance  
Custom Image  
Extended Bracketing/Multi-  
exposure/Interval Shooting/  
Digital Filter/HDR Capture  
8
9
Battery level  
Adjusting composition  
10 Temperature warning  
11 GPS positioning status  
12 Electronic Level  
13 Contrast AF frame  
14 Phase Difference AF frame/AF point  
15 EV Compensation  
16 Histogram  
7
Number of shots using Multi-  
exposure/Cross Processing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
150  
17 AE Lock  
22 Remaining image storage capacity  
18 Shutter speed  
19 Aperture value  
20 EV bar  
23 Main face detection frame  
(Face Detection AF)  
24 Face detection frame (Face  
Detection AF)  
21 Sensitivity  
* Indicator 9 is displayed when switching to Live View after adjusting the  
composition in [Composition Adjust.] (p.195) in the [ Rec. Mode 2] menu.  
A
* Indicator 11 is displayed only when the optional GPS unit is attached to the  
camera and is operating. (p.305)  
* Indicator 12 is displayed when [Electronic Level] is set to O (On). (p.262)  
* Indicator 14 (Phase Difference AF frame) is displayed in white during Live  
View. When the subject is in focus, a green square frame is displayed  
instead. It turns red when the subject is not in focus. It is not displayed  
when the focus mode is set to \.  
* When 18, 19, and 21 can be changed, 5 appears next to the set value.  
* Indicators 23 and 24 are displayed when [Autofocus Method] is set to I  
and the camera detects person’s face(s). When the subject is in focus, a  
green frame is displayed. It turns red when the subject is not in focus.  
4
Available operations  
M button  
Enlarges the image.  
2, 4, or 6 times original size (when the focus mode is  
=)  
2, 4, 6, 8 or 10 times original size (when the focus  
mode is \)  
| button  
Returns the position of the display area to the center  
(during enlarged view).  
Press and hold 4 Switches the function of the four-way controller  
button *1  
(2345) to Change AF point or direct key operation.  
4 button *1  
Returns the position of the AF point to the center  
(when Change AF point is enabled).  
Four-way controller Changes the AF point (when Change AF point is enabled).  
(2345) Moves the display area (during enlarged view).  
*1 Available only when [Autofocus Method] is I or i, and the focus mode is l  
or the AF point switching dial is set to j (Select).  
3
4
Position the subject on the monitor and press the shutter  
release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
When the focus mode is set to \, turn the focusing ring until the subject  
is clearly visible on the focusing screen.  
Press the shutter release button fully.  
The picture is taken.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
151  
• When the focus mode is set to k and [Autofocus Method] is set to i,  
the camera focuses on the center of the screen when autofocus starts and  
then automatically tracks the subject when it is in focus. When [Autofocus  
Method] is set to I, the camera automatically tracks the detected face.  
• Images captured in magnified display are recorded at normal size.  
• You can check the depth of field on the monitor by turning the main switch to  
| during Live View.  
The status screen and control panel cannot be displayed during Live View. To  
change the settings, press the 3 button and change them from each  
menu.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
152  
Recording Movies  
You can record movies using Live View.  
Changing the Movie Settings  
You can record movies with monaural audio in AVI file format.  
1
Select [Movie] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The [Movie] screen appears.  
4
2
Press the four-way controller  
1280x720  
00:31'55"  
(5), use the four-way controller  
(23) to select the number of  
recorded pixels, and press the  
4 button.  
FullHD  
25  
Recorded Pixels  
Quality Level  
Sound  
Cross Processing  
Digital Filter  
HD  
30  
HD  
25  
VGA  
30  
VGA  
25  
Movie Aperture Control Fixed  
Shake Reduction  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Recorded Pixels  
Pixels  
Aspect Ratio  
16:9  
Frame Rate  
25 fps  
a
1920×1080  
1280×720  
1280×720  
640×480  
640×480  
b
b
c
c
(default setting)  
16:9  
30 fps  
16:9  
25 fps  
4:3  
30 fps  
4:3  
25 fps  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Quality Level]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select the quality  
level and press the 4 button.  
Select from C (Best; default setting), D (Better) and E (Good).  
When the recorded pixels and quality level are changed, the amount of  
recordable time at that setting appears at the top right of the screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
153  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Sound] and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select g or Z and  
press the 4 button.  
Records sound. (default setting)  
Does not record sound.  
g
Z
7
Set Cross Processing and Digital Filter as necessary.  
Refer to p.200 for details on Cross Processing and p.143 for Digital Filter.  
4
8
9
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Movie  
Aperture Control] and press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select the [Fixed] or  
[Auto] and press the 4 button.  
The movie is recorded at the aperture value set before movie  
recording starts. (default setting)  
Fixed  
Auto  
The aperture is controlled automatically.  
10 Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Shake  
Reduction] and press the 5 button.  
11 Use the four-way controller (23) to select k or l  
and press the 4 button.  
Uses Shake Reduction.  
k
l
Does not use Shake Reduction. (default setting)  
12 Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to record a movie.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
154  
Connecting a Microphone  
You can connect a commercially available stereo microphone to the  
microphone terminal on the camera and record stereo sound. Using an  
external microphone can also help to reduce the possibility of recording  
camera operation sounds.  
The following specifications are recommended for external microphones.  
• Plug:  
Stereo mini plug (ø3.5 mm)  
Stereo electret condenser  
• Format:  
• Power:  
Plug-in Power Method (operating voltage of 2.0 V or lower)  
2.2 k  
• Impedance:  
4
1
Turn off the camera.  
2
Open the microphone  
terminal cover and  
connect the plug of the  
microphone to the  
microphone terminal  
on the camera.  
3
Turn the camera on.  
If the external microphone is disconnected during recording, the camera  
cannot switch to the internal microphone until recording has stopped. No sound  
will be recorded.  
If you used an external microphone to record movie sound in stereo, the sound  
can be played back in stereo when you use a commercially available HDMI  
cable to output the movie to an HDMI-compatible AV device. If you use an AV  
cable to output the movie, monaural sound is played back. (p.224)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
155  
Recording Movies  
1
Set the mode dial to C.  
Live View for movie recording is  
displayed.  
Sound  
4
HD  
:
F2.8  
00 30'00"  
Recordable Time  
Shake Reduction  
Available operations  
Rear e-dial (S) Changes the aperture value when [Movie Aperture  
Control] is set to [Fixed]. (default setting)  
| button  
Sets the aperture value to obtain a proper exposure.  
(default setting)  
Returns the position of the display area to the center  
(during enlarged view).  
m button +  
Performs EV compensation (up to ±2 EV).  
Rear e-dial (S)  
M button  
Enlarges the image.  
2, 4, or 6 times original size (when the focus mode is  
=)  
2, 4, 6, 8 or 10 times original size (when the focus  
mode is \)  
Press and hold 4 Switches the function of the four-way controller  
button  
(2345) to Change AF point or direct key operation.  
4 button  
Returns the position of the AF point to the center  
(when Change AF point is enabled).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
156  
Four-way controller Changes the AF point (when Change AF point is enabled).  
(2345) Moves the display area (during enlarged view).  
*1 Available only when [Autofocus Method] is I or i, and the focus mode is l  
or the AF point switching dial is set to j (Select).  
2
Position the subject on the monitor and press the shutter  
release button halfway.  
The autofocus system operates.  
When the focus mode is set to \, turn the focusing ring until the subject  
is clearly visible on the focusing screen.  
3
4
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Recording of the movie starts.  
4
Press the shutter release button again.  
Recording stops.  
• When [Sound] is set to g (On), the camera operation sounds are also  
recorded. When recording a movie, mount the camera onto a tripod and do  
not operate the camera while recording.  
• While recording a movie, the autofocus system does not operate.  
• The flash is not available.  
• When recording movies using image processing, such as Digital Filter, some  
frames may be dropped from the recorded movie.  
• If the internal temperature of the camera becomes high during movie  
recording, the recording may be terminated to protect the camera circuitry.  
• You can record movies continuously up to 4 GB or 25 minutes. When the SD  
Memory Card is full, recording stops and the movie is saved.  
• The Live View image in C mode is displayed according to the [Live View]  
settings made in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu. (p.147) However, the Bright/  
Dark Area warning is not displayed during movie recording.  
• You can set the functions for when the front/rear e-dial or the | button is  
operated. (p.247)  
• If you intend to shoot continuously for a long period, use of the AC adapter  
kit (optional) is recommended. (p.52)  
• You can also use the optional remote control to record a movie. (p.127)  
• The sensitivity is fixed to [ISO AUTO].  
• If you want to view a movie on an external monitor while recording it, connect  
the camera to an AV device with a mini HDMI terminal. (p.226) You cannot  
output a movie using the PC/AV terminal while recording.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
157  
Playing Back Movies  
Recorded movies can be played back in Playback mode in the same  
manner as saved still pictures.  
1
Press the Q button.  
The camera switches to Playback mode.  
2
Use the four-way controller (45) to choose a movie to  
play back.  
The first frame of the movie is displayed on the monitor.  
4
3
Press the four-way controller  
(2).  
100-0001  
Movie playback starts.  
Movie 10min00sec  
Available operations  
Four-way controller (2) Pauses/Resumes playback.  
Rear e-dial (S) Volume control (6 levels)  
Four-way controller (5) Forwards a frame (during pause).  
Press and hold four-way Fast-forwards playback while pressed.  
controller (5)  
Four-way controller (4) Reverses playback./  
Reverses a frame (during pause).  
Press and hold four-way Fast-reverses playback while pressed.  
controller (4)  
Four-way controller (3) Stops playback./  
Displays the playback mode palette (when stopped). (p.208)  
L button  
Saves the displayed image in JPEG format (during pause).  
When the movie ends, playback stops and the first frame is displayed again.  
• You can use the provided AV cable or a commercially available HDMI cable  
to play back the recorded movies on a TV screen or other AV devices. (p.224)  
Even if you used an external microphone to record movie sound in stereo, monaural  
sound is played back when you output the movie via the PC/AV terminal. When you  
output the movie via the mini HDMI terminal, sound is played back in stereo.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
158  
Capturing a Still Picture from a Movie  
You can capture a single frame from a movie and save it as a JPEG still  
picture.  
1
Press the four-way controller (2)  
in Step 3 on p.157 to pause the  
movie, and display the frame to  
save as a still picture.  
Frame number/Total number  
of frames  
90/1800  
AE-L  
While paused, you can forward or  
reverse the movie in one-frame  
increments using the four-way controller  
(45).  
4
The frame number and total number of  
frames appear at the top right of the  
screen.  
Movie 10min00sec  
2
3
Press the L button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The captured image is saved as a new image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
159  
Editing Movies  
Movies can be divided and unwanted segments can be deleted.  
1
Press the Q button.  
The camera switches to Playback mode.  
2
Use the four-way controller (45) to choose a movie to  
play back.  
The first frame of the movie is displayed on the monitor.  
4
3
4
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select [ (Movie  
Editing) and press the 4 button.  
The movie editing screen appears.  
5
Select point(s) where you want to  
divide the movie.  
The first frame at the dividing point is  
00min00sec  
displayed at the top of the screen.  
10min00sec  
Up to four points can be selected (divided  
into five segments).  
OK  
MENU  
Exit  
OK  
Available operations  
Four-way controller (2)  
Plays back/Pauses a movie.  
Four-way controller (5)  
Moves forward 1 second (during pause).  
Moves to the next dividing point (during  
playback).  
Four-way controller (4)  
Moves backward 1 second (during pause).  
Moves to the previous dividing point (during  
playback).  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Volume control (6 levels)  
| button  
Confirms/cancels a dividing point.  
Proceed to Step 9 if you do not want to delete any segment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
160  
6
7
Press the i button.  
The screen to select the segment(s) to delete is displayed.  
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to move the selection frame and  
press the 4 button.  
00min02sec  
10min00sec  
The segment(s) to delete are specified.  
Multiple segments can be deleted at  
once.  
Select segments for deletion  
OK  
MENU  
Press the 4 button again to cancel the  
selection.  
4
8
9
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 5 appears again.  
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
10 Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The movie is divided at the specified points and the unwanted segments  
are deleted from it. The divided movie is then saved as separate files and  
the single image display reappears.  
• Select dividing points in chronological order from the beginning of the movie.  
When canceling the selected dividing points, cancel each of them in reverse  
order (from the end of the movie to the beginning). In an order other than  
specified, you can neither select frames as a dividing point nor cancel the  
selections of the dividing points. You cannot, for example, select the frames  
prior to the last selected frame as a dividing point while selecting a dividing  
point.  
• Movies with a short recording time cannot be divided.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5 Using the Flash  
This chapter provides details on the built-in flash of this  
camera and describes how to take pictures with the external  
flash.  
Using the Built-in Flash .....................................162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
162  
Using the Built-in Flash  
Flash Characteristics in Each Exposure Mode  
Using the Flash in b Mode  
• Any desired shutter speed of 1/180 sec. or slower can be set for taking a  
flash photograph.  
• The shutter speed is locked at 1/180 sec. when a lens other than a DA,  
DA L, D FA, FA J, FA, F or A lens is used.  
Using the Flash in c Mode  
• The shutter speed shifts automatically anywhere from 1/180 sec. to a  
slow shutter speed that reduces camera shake. The slowest shutter  
speed depends on the focal length of the lens in use.  
5
• The shutter speed is locked at 1/180 sec. when a lens other than a DA,  
DA L, D FA, FA J, FA or F lens is used.  
Using the Slow-speed Sync  
You can use slow-speed-sync in b (Shutter Priority Automatic Exposure)  
mode when shooting portraits with the sunset in the background. Both the  
portrait and the background are captured beautifully.  
• Slow-speed Sync slows the shutter speed. Use the Shake Reduction function  
or turn off the Shake Reduction function and use a tripod to avoid camera  
shake. The picture will also blur if the subject moves.  
• Slow-speed Sync shooting can also be performed with an external flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
163  
Using e/K/c Mode  
1
Set the mode dial to e, K or c.  
2
3
4
Press the E button.  
The built-in flash pops up.  
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
Select G or H and press the 4 button.  
The shutter speed is set slower to give a proper exposure for the  
background.  
5
Using b/L/a Mode  
1
Set the mode dial to b, L or a.  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
3
4
Select E or F and press the 4 button.  
Set the shutter speed (for b mode) or shutter speed and  
aperture value (for L or a mode).  
Set so a proper exposure is obtained at a shutter speed of 1/180 second  
or slower.  
5
Press the E button.  
The built-in flash pops up.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
164  
Using the Trailing Curtain Sync  
Trailing Curtain Sync discharges the flash immediately before the shutter  
curtain closes. When shooting moving objects with a slow shutter speed,  
Trailing Curtain Sync and Slow-speed Sync produce different effects  
depending on when the flash is discharged.  
For example, when shooting a moving car with Trailing Curtain Sync,  
trailing light is captured while the shutter is open and the flash captures the  
car immediately before the shutter is closed. Therefore, the picture will  
include a sharp, well-lit car with trailing light behind it.  
5
Slow-speed Sync  
Trailing Curtain Sync  
(Leading Curtain Sync)  
1
Set the mode dial to any mode other than B, M or C.  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
3
4
Select I or k and press the 4 button.  
Press the E button.  
The built-in flash pops up.  
Trailing Curtain Sync slows the shutter speed. Use the Shake Reduction  
function or turn off the Shake Reduction function and use a tripod to avoid  
camera shake.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
165  
Distance and Aperture when Using the Built-in Flash  
Relationships between the guide number, aperture and distance must be  
considered when shooting with the flash to obtain a correct exposure.  
Calculate and adjust the shooting conditions if the flash output is not sufficient.  
Sensitivity Built-in Flash Guide Number Sensitivity Built-in flash guide number  
ISO 100  
ISO 200  
ISO 400  
ISO 800  
ISO 1600  
Approx. 13  
Approx. 18.4  
Approx. 26  
Approx. 36.8  
Approx. 52  
ISO 3200  
ISO 6400  
ISO 12800  
ISO 25600 *1  
ISO 51200 *1  
Approx. 73.5  
Approx. 104  
Approx. 147  
Approx. 208  
Approx. 294  
*1 This can be used when [3. Expanded Sensitivity] in the [  
A
Custom Setting 1] menu is set to [On].  
Calculating Shooting Distance from Aperture Value  
5
The following equation calculates the effective distance of the flash.  
Maximum flash distance L1 = Guide number ÷ Aperture value  
Minimum flash distance L2 = Maximum flash distance ÷ 5 *  
* The value 5 used in the formula above is a fixed value  
which applies only when using the built-in flash alone.  
Example: When the sensitivity is ISO 100 and the aperture value is F2.8  
L1 = 13 ÷ 2.8 = approx. 4.6 (m)  
L2 = 4.6 ÷ 5 = approx. 0.9 (m)  
Therefore, the flash can be used in a range of about 0.9 m to 4.6 m.  
However, the built-in flash in this camera cannot be used when the  
distance is 0.7 m or less. When the flash is used at closer than 0.7  
m, it causes vignetting in the picture corners, light is distributed  
unevenly and a picture may be overexposed.  
Calculating Aperture Value from Shooting Distance  
The following equation calculates the aperture value for shooting distances.  
Aperture value F = Guide number ÷ Shooting distance  
Example: When the sensitivity is ISO 100 and shooting distance is 4 m,  
the aperture value is:  
F = 13 ÷ 4 = 3.25  
If the resulting number (3.25, in the above example) is not available  
as a lens aperture, the smaller number that is closest (2.8, in the  
above example) is generally used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
166  
Lens Compatibility with the Built-in Flash  
Depending on the lens used with this camera, the use of the built-in flash  
may not be available or may be limited due to vignetting.  
The built-in flash cannot be regulated and fully discharges when A lenses  
not set to the s (Auto) position, lenses manufactured prior to the A lenses  
or soft focus lenses are used.  
DA, DA L, D FA, FA J, and FA lenses not listed below can be used without  
problems.  
* The following lenses were evaluated without a hood.  
Unavailable due to vignetting  
Lens Name  
DA FISH-EYE 10-17mm F3.5-4.5ED (IF)  
DA12-24mm F4ED AL  
DA14mm F2.8ED (IF)  
5
E
FA 300mm F2.8ED (IF)  
E
FA 600mm F4ED (IF)  
E
FA 250-600mm F5.6ED (IF)  
Available with some restrictions  
Lens Name  
Restrictions  
Vignetting may occur if the focal length is  
less than 20 mm.  
F FISH-EYE 17-28mm F3.5-4.5  
When the focal length is less than 28 mm or  
when the focal length is 28 mm and the shooting  
distance is 1 m or less, vignetting may occur.  
DA16-45mm F4ED AL  
When the focal length is 20 mm or less or  
when the focal length is 35 mm and the  
shooting distance is less than 1.5 m,  
vignetting may occur.  
E
DA 16-50mm F2.8ED AL (IF) SDM  
When the focal length is less than 24 mm or  
when the focal length is 24 mm and the shooting  
distance is 1 m or less, vignetting may occur.  
DA17-70mm F4AL (IF) SDM  
Vignetting may occur if the focal length is  
less than 35 mm.  
DA18-250mm F3.5-6.3ED AL (IF)  
Vignetting may occur if the focal length is  
28 mm and the shooting distance is less than  
1 m.  
E
FA 28-70mm F2.8AL  
FA SOFT 28mm F2.8/  
FA SOFT 85mm F2.8  
Built-in flash always discharges fully.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
167  
Using an External Flash (Optional)  
Using an optional external flash AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ, AF200FG or  
AF160FC enables a variety of flash modes such as P-TTL auto flash mode.  
(z: Available #: Restricted ×: Not available)  
Flash  
Built-in  
Flash  
AF540FGZ AF200FG  
AF360FGZ AF160FC  
Camera Function  
Red-eye reduction flash  
Auto flash discharge  
z
z
z
z
z
z
After the flash is charged, the camera  
automatically switches to the flash sync  
speed.  
z
z
z
z
Aperture value is automatically set in e  
mode and b mode.  
z
z
z
z
5
P-TTL auto flash (appropriate sensitivity:  
ISO 100 to 3200)  
z
Slow-speed Sync  
z
z
×
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
×
Flash exposure compensation  
AF assist light of external flash  
Trailing Curtain Sync  
z
×
Contrast-control-sync flash mode  
Slave flash  
#
#
×
×
×
×
×
High-speed flash sync  
Wireless flash  
#
*1 Available only when using a DA, DA L, D FA, FA J, FA, F or A lens.  
*2 Shutter speed of 1/90 sec. or slower.  
*3 When combined with the AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ, 1/3 of the flash discharge can be  
output by the built-in flash and 2/3 can be output by the external flash.  
*4 Available only when combined with the AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ.  
*5 Multiple AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ units, or a combination of an AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ  
unit and the built-in flash is required.  
• Flashes with reversed polarity (the center contact on the hot shoe is minus)  
cannot be used due to the risk of damaging the camera and flash.  
• Do not combine with accessories that have a different number of contacts,  
such as a Hot Shoe Grip, as a malfunction may occur.  
• Combining with flashes from other manufacturers may cause equipment  
breakdown. We recommend using the AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ or AF200FG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
168  
About the Display Panel for AF360FGZ  
The AF360FGZ itself does not have the function to set the FORMAT size  
to [DIGITAL]. However, when it is used with a SLR Digital Camera, the  
difference in focal length between a 35 mm camera and this camera is  
automatically calculated based on the difference in angle of view and is  
displayed on the panel (when using DA, DA L, D FA, FA J, FA or F lens).  
The conversion indicator appears and the FORMAT size indicator  
disappears when the exposure metering timer of this camera is on (it  
returns to 35 mm format display when the exposure metering timer is  
turned off).  
85mm  
/77mm  
28mm  
/24mm  
Lens Focal Length  
50mm 35mm  
20mm 18mm  
Exposure metering timer  
Off  
24mm*  
16mm*  
85mm 70mm 50mm 35mm 28mm  
58mm 48mm 34mm 24mm 19mm  
Exposure metering timer  
On  
5
* Using wide-angle panel  
Using the P-TTL Auto Flash  
You can use the P-TTL auto flash with an AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ,  
AF200FG or AF160FC flash unit.  
The flash pre-flashes before the actual flash and confirms the subject (the  
distance, brightness, contrast, whether it is backlit, etc.) using the camera 77-  
segment metering sensor. The flash output for the actual flash is adjusted based  
on the information obtained from the pre-flash, enabling flash photography with  
more accurate exposure for the subject than with normal TTL auto.  
1
Remove the cover of the hot shoe and attach the external  
flash.  
2
3
4
Turn on the camera and the external flash.  
Set the external flash mode to [P-TTL].  
Confirm that the external flash is fully charged and then  
take a picture.  
The b will light in the viewfinder when the flash is ready (fully charged).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
169  
• For details such as operation method and effective distance, please refer to  
the external flash manual.  
• The flash does not discharge if the subject is bright enough when the flash  
mode is C or i. Therefore, it may not be suitable for Daylight-Sync  
shooting.  
• Never press the E button when any external flash unit is attached to the  
camera. The built-in flash will hit the external flash. If you want to use both at  
once, set the wireless mode or connect them using the extension cord.  
(p.173)  
Using High-Speed Flash Sync Mode  
With the AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ, you can discharge the flash to take a  
picture at a shutter speed faster than 1/180 second.  
5
1
Remove the cover of the hot shoe and attach the external  
flash.  
2
Set the exposure mode to e, b, L or a.  
Select an exposure mode which allows you to set the shutter speed.  
3
4
Turn on the camera and the external flash.  
Set the external flash sync mode to HSb (High-speed  
flash sync).  
5
Confirm that the external flash is fully charged and then  
take a picture.  
The b will light in the viewfinder when the flash is ready (fully charged).  
High-speed flash sync is available only when the shutter speed is set faster  
than 1/180 sec.  
• High-speed flash sync is not available when the exposure mode is set to p  
(Bulb Exposure).  
• High-speed sync is not available with the built-in flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
170  
Using Flash in Wireless Mode  
By using two external flashes (AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ) or using the  
built-in flash with one or more external flashes, you can shoot in P-TTL  
flash mode without connecting the flash units with a cord.  
• Set the power switch of the external flash to WIRELESS.  
• Two or more AF540FGZ/AF360FGZ external flashes are required to use  
high-speed flash sync in wireless mode. This function cannot be used in  
combination with the built-in flash.  
• Set the wireless mode of the external flashes not directly connected to the  
camera to SLAVE.  
Setting the Channel for the External Flash  
First, set the channel for the external flash unit.  
5
1
Set the channel for the external flash unit.  
2
Remove the cover of the hot shoe and attach the external  
flash.  
3
Turn on the camera and the external flash, and press the  
shutter release button halfway.  
The built-in flash is set to the same channel as the external flash unit.  
Be sure to set all the flashes to the same channel. Refer to the manual of the  
AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ for details on how to set the channel on the external  
flash.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
171  
Wireless Shooting Using a Combination of the Built-in  
Flash and an External Flash Unit  
Set the camera to wireless flash mode when using an external flash in  
combination with the built-in flash.  
1
Remove the external flash unit after the channel is set on  
the camera, and place it at the desired location.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The [Flash Mode] screen appears.  
Select r and press the 4  
button.  
Flash Mode  
Wireless Mode  
5
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
The channel for the built-in flash is  
displayed in the viewfinder and on the  
LCD panel. The factory default setting is  
0.0  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
CH1.  
4
5
Press the E button.  
Confirm that both flashes are fully charged, and then take  
a picture.  
r cannot be set when the exposure mode is set to B (Green).  
• When the drive mode is set to i (Remote Control (3s delay)), d (Mirror  
Lock-up) or e (Mirror Lock-up + Remote Control), or the lens aperture is not  
set to the s position, r cannot be selected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
172  
Changing the Built-in Flash Discharge Method  
You can change the built-in flash discharge method used in wireless  
mode.  
Set in [21. Flash in Wireless Mode] of the [A Custom Setting 3]  
menu.  
1
2
On Discharges the built-in flash as a master. (default setting)  
Off Discharges the built-in flash as a control flash.  
HSb (High-speed flash sync) is not available with the built-in flash.  
Wireless Shooting Using a Combination of External  
Flash Units  
5
1
Set the wireless mode of the external flash directly  
connected to the camera to [MASTER] or [CONTROL].  
Discharges both the flash directly connected to the  
MASTER  
camera and the wireless flash unit as the main flash.  
Discharges the flash directly connected to the camera as  
CONTROL  
a control flash only, not as the main flash.  
2
3
On the wireless remote flash unit, set the wireless flash  
mode to [SLAVE] and set the channel to the same channel  
as the flash directly connected to the camera. Then, place  
it at the desired location.  
Confirm that both flashes are fully charged and then take  
a picture.  
• The Shake Reduction function is automatically turned off in wireless mode.  
• When using multiple AF540FGZ/AF360FGZ external flashes and performing  
high-speed flash sync shooting in wireless mode, set the flash directly  
connected to the camera to high-speed flash sync mode.  
• When the wireless mode of the external flash directly connected to the  
camera is set to [MASTER] or [21. Flash in Wireless Mode] (p.172) is set to  
[On] for the built-in flash, all the flashes will discharge simultaneously.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
173  
Connecting an External Flash with an  
Extension Cord  
When using an external flash away from the camera, attach the Hot Shoe  
Adapter FG (1; optional) to the camera hot shoe and an Off-Camera Shoe  
Adapter F (2; optional) to the bottom of the external flash, and then  
connect these with the Extension Cord F5P (3; optional). The Off-  
Camera Shoe Adapter F can be mounted to your tripod using the tripod  
screw.  
When combining with the built-in flash  
2
1
5
3
Multiple Flash Shooting Using Extension Cords  
You can combine two or more external flashes (AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ or  
AF200FG) or you can use two or more external flashes in combination with  
the built-in flash.  
For connecting the AF540FGZ flash unit, you can use the extension cord  
connection terminal on the flash. For connecting the AF360FGZ or  
AF200FG flash unit, as shown in the following illustration, connect an  
external flash and the Hot Shoe Adapter F (4; optional) to the Off-Camera  
Shoe Adapter F (2; optional) and then connect another Off-Camera Shoe  
Adapter F (2) with another external flash using the Extension Cord F5P  
(3; optional).  
Refer to the manual of the flash for details.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
174  
When combining two or more external flashes  
2
4
3
3
1
2
When using multiple external flashes or using an external flash with the built-in  
flash, P-TTL is used for flash control.  
Contrast-Control-Sync Flash  
5
Combining two or more external flashes (AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ or  
AF200FG) or using an external flash in combination with the built-in flash  
allows multiple flash photography (contrast-control-sync flash  
photography). This is based on the difference between the amounts of  
light discharged from multiple units.  
The AF200FG must be combined with the AF540FGZ or AF360FGZ.  
1
Connect the external flash to the camera indirectly.  
2
3
Set the sync mode for the external flash to contrast-  
control-sync mode.  
Confirm that both the external flash and built-in flash are  
fully charged and then take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
175  
• When using two or more external flashes and the contrast-control-sync mode  
is set on the external master flash unit, the flash output ratio is 2 (master unit)  
: 1 (slave units). When an external flash is used in combination with the built-  
in flash, the flash output ratio is 2 (external flash) : 1 (built-in flash).  
• When using multiple external flashes or using an external flash with the built-  
in flash, P-TTL is used for flash control.  
X-sync Socket  
You can connect an external flash to the  
camera with a sync cord by using the X-sync  
socket.  
Remove the Sync socket 2P cap and  
connect a sync cord to the X-sync socket.  
5
• The use of high-voltage or high-current external flashes may cause a camera  
breakdown.  
• Flashes with reversed polarity (the center of the sync plug is minus) cannot  
be used due to the risk of damaging the camera and flash.  
• When a sync cord is connected to the X-sync socket, linked functions will not  
work.  
• To prevent vignetting caused from Trailing Curtain Sync, it is recommended  
to take a test shot using a shutter speed one level slower than the flash sync  
speed.  
The contact of the X-sync socket is not dust-proof and water-resistant. Attach  
the provided Sync socket 2P cap when not in use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
176  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6 Shooting Settings  
This chapter describes how to set the save format for  
pictures taken and other settings.  
Setting a File Format ..........................................178  
Setting the White Balance .................................183  
Correcting Images ..............................................190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
178  
Setting a File Format  
Setting the JPEG Recorded Pixels  
You can select the number of recorded pixels from p, J, P and i.  
The default setting is p.  
Recorded Pixels  
Pixels  
p
J
P
i
4928×3264  
3936×2624  
3072×2048  
1728×1152  
1
Select [JPEG Recorded Pixels] in the [A Rec. Mode 1]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
6
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the number of recorded  
4928x3264  
120  
JPEG  
File Format  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
AF Settings  
16M  
10M  
6M  
pixels and press the 4 button.  
When the number of recorded pixels is  
changed, the number of pixels appears at  
the top left of the screen and the number  
of recordable images for that setting  
appears at the top right of the screen.  
Lens Correction  
2M  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
179  
Setting the JPEG Quality Level  
You can set the image quality level (compression ratio). The default setting  
is C (Best).  
Z Premium  
Images will be clearer but file size will be larger.  
Images will be grainier but file size will be smaller.  
C Best  
D
E
Better  
Good  
1
Select [JPEG Quality] in the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a quality level and press  
the 4 button.  
120  
File Format  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
JPEG  
16M  
AF Settings  
Lens Correction  
6
When the quality level is changed, the  
number of recordable images at that  
quality level appears at the top right of the  
screen.  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
180  
Setting a File Format  
You can set the format of image files.  
Captures images in JPEG format. (default setting)  
JPEG You can change the number of recorded pixels in [JPEG Recorded  
Pixels] and the image quality level in [JPEG Quality].  
RAW format is a CMOS sensor output format saved without  
processing.  
Effects of White Balance, Custom Image and Color Space are not  
RAW applied to the captured images, but they are saved as actual original  
information. When you perform the development process by using the  
[RAW Development] function (p.238), you can create JPEG images  
with these effects.  
Images are saved in both RAW and JPEG formats.  
When [One Push File Format] is assigned to the |/Y button, you  
can press the |/Y button to temporarily change the file format and  
RAW+  
save an image in both file formats. (p.181)  
When Extended Bracketing, Digital Filter, HDR Capture or Cross Processing is  
set, the file format is set to [JPEG] and cannot be changed. To change the file  
format, turn these functions off.  
6
1
Select [File Format] in the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a file format.  
120  
File Format  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
AF Settings  
Lens Correction  
JPEG  
RAW  
RAW+  
When the file format is changed, the  
number of recordable images appears at  
the top right of the screen.  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
181  
Setting the RAW File Format  
You can select PEF or DNG format in [RAW  
File Format] of the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu  
when capturing images in RAW format.  
1
2
3
4 5  
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
ISO  
NR  
AUTO  
AUTO  
NR  
Color Space  
RAW File Format  
PEF
DNG  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
PENTAX’s original RAW file format (default setting)  
PEF  
General-purpose, publicly available RAW file format designed by  
Adobe Systems  
DNG  
Temporarily Changing the File Format using the  
|/Y Button  
When [One Push File Format] is assigned to the |/Y button, you can  
temporarily change the file format.  
6
1
Select [Button Customization] in the [A Rec. Mode 5]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Button Customization] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [|/Y  
Button] and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [|/Y Button] screen appears.  
3
4
Press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [One Push File Format]  
and press the 4 button.  
RAW/Fx Button  
One Push File Format  
Exposure Bracketing  
Digital Preview  
Electronic Level  
Composition Adjust.  
GPS  
RAW  
GPS  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
182  
5
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Cancel after 1  
shot] and use the four-way controller (45) to select O or  
P.  
The recording format returns to the original file format after a  
picture is taken. (default setting)  
O
The setting is canceled when the following operations are  
performed.  
- the |/Y button is pressed again  
- the Q button or 3 button is pressed  
P
- the main switch is turned off  
- the mode dial is turned  
6
7
Use the four-way controller (23) to choose a file format.  
The left side is the [File Format] setting and the right side is the file format  
when the |/Y button is pressed.  
Press the four-way controller  
RAW/Fx Button  
6
(5), and use the four-way  
RAW One Push File Format  
controller (23) to select a file  
Cancel after 1 shot  
format when the |/Y button  
is pressed.  
JPEG  
RAW  
JPEG
RAW  
RAW+  
RAW+  
RAW+  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
8
9
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button three times.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
183  
Setting the White Balance  
Adjusts the color of an image based on ambient light conditions so that  
white objects appear white.  
Item  
Setting  
Automatically adjusts the white balance. Approx. 4,000 to  
(default setting) 8,000K  
Color Temperature *1  
Auto  
F
G
Daylight  
Shade  
Cloudy  
For use when taking pictures in sunlight. Approx. 5,200K  
For use when taking pictures in the shade.  
Approx. 8,000K  
H
^
It reduces the bluish color tones in a picture.  
For use when taking pictures on cloudy days. Approx. 6,000K  
For use when taking pictures under  
fluorescent lighting. Select the type of  
fluorescent light.  
Fluorescent  
Light  
D Fluorescent Light Daylight Color  
N Fluorescent Light Daylight White  
W Fluorescent Light Cool White  
Approx. 6,500K  
Approx. 5,000K  
Approx. 4,200K  
Approx. 3,000K  
J
L
Fluorescent Light Warm White  
6
For use when taking pictures under light  
bulbs or other tungsten light. It reduces  
the reddish color tones in a picture.  
Tungsten  
Light  
Approx. 2,850K  
I
For use when taking pictures using the  
built-in flash.  
Flash  
Approx. 5,400K  
-
L
Use this to keep and strengthen the color  
tone of the light source in the image.  
CTE  
Use this to manually adjust the white  
balance according to the lighting when  
taking pictures. You can save three  
settings.  
Manual 1-3  
-
-
K
Color  
Temperature  
1~3  
Use figures to set the color temperature.  
You can save three settings.  
K
*1 The color temperatures (K) shown above are all estimates. These do not indicate precise  
colors.  
*2 CTE = Color Temperature Enhancement  
White balance is fixed to F when the exposure mode is set to B (Green),  
or when Cross Processing is set.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
184  
1
Press the four-way controller (4) in Capture mode.  
The [White Balance] screen appears.  
The last image taken after the camera was turned on is displayed in the  
background.  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the white balance.  
White Balance  
Auto  
When J is selected, press the four-way  
controller (5) and use the four-way  
controller (23) to select D, N, W, or L.  
CTE  
1
K1  
Proceed to Step 6 if you do not need to  
AE.L  
change the parameters.  
OK  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
Available operations  
Main switch (|)  
Uses Digital Preview to preview the background image  
with the setting applied. (Not available during Live View.)  
L button  
Saves the background image. (Not available during  
Live View.)  
6
3
4
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The fine-tuning screen appears.  
Fine-tune the white balance.  
Shade  
G
B
A
G1  
0
0
M
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Available operations  
Four-way controller (23) Adjusts the tone of the colors between green  
(G) and magenta (M).  
Four-way controller (45) Adjusts the tone of the colors between blue (B)  
and amber (A).  
| button  
Resets the adjustment value.  
5
Press the 4 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 2 appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
185  
6
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• The camera automatically performs fine-tuning even when the light source is  
specified. The color temperature of the light source is fixed when [10. WB  
Adjustable Range] is set to [Fixed] in the [A Custom Setting 2] menu.  
• Because the light source changes when a flash discharges, you can set the  
white balance for when the flash discharges. Select [Auto White Balance],  
[Unchanged] or [Flash] in [11. WB When Using Flash] of the [A Custom  
Setting 2] menu.  
Adjusting the White Balance Manually  
You can adjust the white balance depending on the light source when  
taking pictures. Up to three settings can be saved.  
1
Select K in Step 2 on p.184 and press the four-way  
controller (5).  
6
2
Use the four-way controller  
White Balance  
Manual 1  
(23) to select K1 to K3 and  
press the four-way controller  
(5).  
1
2
3
CTE  
1
K1  
AE.L  
OK  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
3
Under the light to measure the  
white balance, fully display a  
white sheet of paper in the  
viewfinder or select a white area  
as the subject.  
1
Manual  
White Balance  
SHUTTER  
Adjust  
G
B
A
0
0
0
M
AE.L  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
186  
4
5
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Set the focus mode to \ when the shutter cannot be released.  
The screen to select the measuring range is displayed.  
Use the rear e-dial (S) to select  
1
the entire screen or spot area for  
the measuring range.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
6
7
When a spot area is selected, use the four-way controller  
(2345) to move the frame to the position you want to  
measure.  
Press the 4 button.  
6
The white balance is measured, and the screen that was displayed in  
Step 3 appears again.  
Adjust the white balance as necessary.  
The message [The operation could not be completed correctly] appears  
when measuring is unsuccessful. Press the 4 button to remeasure the  
white balance.  
8
Press the 4 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• If a picture is extremely overexposed or underexposed, the white balance  
may not be adjusted. In this case, adjust exposure to the correct amount level  
before adjusting the white balance.  
• When the mode dial is set to C (Movie), the white balance cannot be  
measured. Adjust the white balance in any exposure mode other than C  
before recording a movie.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
187  
Saving the White Balance Settings of a Captured Image  
You can copy the white balance settings of a captured image and save it  
as Manual White Balance.  
Only the white balance settings of still pictures captured with this camera can  
be copied. The following images cannot be selected.  
- Multi-exposure image  
- Index image  
- Still pictures captured from a movie  
1
In Playback mode, display the image with the white  
balance settings you want to copy.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select K (Save  
as Manual WB) and press the 4 button.  
6
The save confirmation screen appears.  
You can turn the front e-dial (R) to select a different image.  
4
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a number and press the  
100-0105  
Saves this image's White  
Balance settings as a custom  
4 button.  
selection  
The white balance settings of the  
selected image is saved to Manual White  
Save as Manual 1  
Save as Manual 2  
Save as Manual 3  
Balance and the camera switches to  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Capture mode. The white balance setting  
is K (Manual).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
188  
Adjusting the White Balance with Color  
Temperature  
Use figures to set the color temperature. Up to three settings can be  
saved.  
1
Select K in Step 2 on p.184 and press the four-way  
controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select K1 to K3 and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Color Temperature] screen appears.  
3
Adjust the color temperature  
with the front or rear e-dial.  
Color  
Temperature  
K1  
G
5000K  
You can set the color temperature value  
within the range from 2500K to 10000K.  
6
B
A
0
0
M
0
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Color temperature steps vary depending on the e-dial.  
E-dial  
Kelvin  
1 Step (100K)  
Mired  
1 Step (20M)  
5 Steps (100M)  
Front (R)  
Rear (S)  
10 Steps (1,000K)  
*1 The default setting for Color Temperature step units is [Kelvin]. You can change the  
step units to [Mired] in [13. Color Temperature Steps] of the [A Custom Setting 2]  
menu. However, figures are converted to Kelvin and displayed.  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the [White Balance] screen.  
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
189  
Setting the Color Space  
You can select a color space to use.  
sRGB  
Sets to sRGB color space. (default setting)  
AdobeRGB Sets to AdobeRGB color space.  
Set in [Color Space] of the [A Rec. Mode 3]  
1
2
3
4 5  
menu.  
D-Range Setting  
ISO AUTO Setting  
High-ISO NR  
ISO  
NR  
AUTO  
AUTO  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
NR  
Color Space  
sRGB  
RAW File Format  
Ad  
ob  
e
RGB  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
The file naming system changes depending on the color space setting as  
shown below.  
For sRGB: IMGPxxxx.JPG  
For AdobeRGB: _IGPxxxx.JPG  
6
“xxxx” indicates the file number. This is displayed as a four-digit sequential  
number. (p.264)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
190  
Correcting Images  
The camera and lens properties can be automatically adjusted for when  
taking pictures.  
Adjusting Brightness  
Adjusts the brightness and reduces the occurrence of overexposed and  
underexposed areas.  
D-Range Setting  
Expands the dynamic range and enables a more ample gradation  
expression by the CMOS sensor and reduces the occurrence of  
overexposed and underexposed areas.  
6
1
Select [D-Range Setting] in the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [D-Range Setting] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Highlight  
Correction] and press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
D-Range Setting  
to select [Off] or [On] and press  
the 4 button.  
OFF  
Highlight Correction  
Shadow Correction  
ON  
Available sensitivity range is  
currently ISO 100-12800  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Shadow  
Correction] and press the four-way controller (5).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
191  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Off], [Low], [Medium] or  
[High] and press the 4 button.  
D-Range Setting  
OFF  
Highlight Correction  
Shadow Correction  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
When [Highlight Correction] is set to [On], the minimum sensitivity is set to ISO  
200. When [3. Expanded Sensitivity] is set to [On] in the [A Custom Setting 1]  
menu, the minimum sensitivity is set to ISO 160.  
HDR Capture  
6
Enables capturing images with high dynamic range. Takes three images  
(-3 EV underexposed, standard (proper exposure) and +3 EV  
overexposed) to create a single composite image with them.  
• HDR Capture is not available in the following situations.  
- when the file format is set to [RAW] or [RAW+] (fixed to [JPEG])  
- when the exposure mode is set to p (Bulb Exposure) or M (Flash X-sync  
Speed)  
• When HDR Capture is set, the following functions are not available.  
- Flash discharge  
- Drive modes other than 9 (Single Frame Shooting), g (Self-timer (12  
sec.)), Z (Self-timer (2 sec.)), h (Remote Control) or i (Remote Control  
(3s delay))  
- Interval Shooting or Multi-exposure  
- Extended Bracketing, Digital Filter or Cross Processing (The function  
selected last is used.)  
• During HDR Capture, multiple images are combined together to create a  
single image, so it will take time to save an image.  
1
Select [HDR Capture] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [HDR Capture] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
192  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [Off], [Auto],  
[Standard], [Strong 1], [Strong 2]  
or [Strong 3].  
HDR Capture  
HDR  
OFF  
HDR  
AUTO  
HDR Capture  
Auto Align  
HDR  
HDR  
HDR  
HDR  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Auto Align]  
and use the four-way controller (45) to select P or O.  
[Shake Reduction] is fixed to l (Off). Use a tripod to prevent  
camera shake when taking pictures. (default setting)  
P
The Shake Reduction function operates according to the Shake  
Reduction setting at that point. HDR Capture can be used without a tripod.  
[Program Line] (p.89) is fixed to l (Hi-speed Priority) and [AUTO  
O
6
ISO Parameters] (p.84) is fixed to a (Fast).  
5
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
• During HDR Capture, pressing the 3 button while an image is being  
saved cancels the process and saves the image as a standard image.  
• When both [Shake Reduction] and [Auto Align] are set to on, be careful of the  
following points.  
- Make sure to hold the camera firmly so that the composition of the picture  
does not change while the three images are taken. If there is a great  
difference of the composition between three images, [Auto Align] may not  
be possible.  
- Images taken with HDR Capture are susceptible to camera shake and blur.  
Be sure to set a higher shutter speed and a higher ISO sensitivity.  
- When the exposure mode is set to e (Program Automatic Exposure),  
[Program Line] is set to l (Hi-speed Priority).  
- When the ISO sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO], the sensitivity can be raised  
more easily than normal.  
- [Auto Align] may not be possible for lenses that have a focal length  
exceeding 100 mm.  
- When the entire subject is checkered or has a uniform surface, [Auto Align]  
may not be possible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
193  
Lens Correction  
Reduces distortions and lateral chromatic aberrations occurring due to  
lens properties.  
 Distortion  
Distortion is the phenomenon in which the center of the image appears  
inflated (barrel distortion) or the center of the image appears pinched  
(pincushion distortion). Distortion occurs more easily when using a  
zoom lens or a small diameter lens, and straight walls or the horizon in  
the image appear curved.  
6
Pincushion distortion  
Barrel distortion  
 Lateral chromatic aberration  
Lateral chromatic aberration is the phenomenon in which the  
magnification of the image varies according to the colors (wavelengths  
of light) when a picture was taken, and may cause a blurred image.  
Lateral chromatic aberration occurs more easily at shorter focal lengths.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
194  
• Corrections can only be made when using DA, DA L, D FA or some FA  
lenses. [Lens Correction] cannot be selected when an incompatible lens is  
attached. (p.297)  
• The Lens Correction function is disabled when using an accessory such as a  
close-up ring or rear converter that is attached between the camera and the  
lens.  
• When the Lens Correction function is activated, it may take longer to display  
Instant Review and the shooting speed for continuous shooting may be  
slower.  
• The effect of the Lens Correction function may be barely noticeable in some  
cases due to the shooting conditions or other factors.  
1
Select [Lens Correction] in the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Lens Correction] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Distortion  
Correction] or [Lat-Chromatic-Ab Adj].  
6
Press the four-way controller (5)  
Lens Correction  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [OFF] or [ON].  
OFF  
Distortion Correction  
Lat-Chromatic-Ab Adj  
ON  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
When a compatible lens is attached and the file format is set to [RAW] or  
[RAW+], the correction information is saved as a RAW file parameter and you  
can select [On] or [Off] when developing the RAW images. (p.238)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
195  
Adjusting the Composition  
Adjusts the Shake Reduction unit in the X-Y direction or rotation direction  
for a better composition position and a more level camera. Use this when  
you want to adjust the composition, such as when using a tripod.  
1
Select [Composition Adjust.] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Composition Adjust.] screen appears.  
2
Select [Start Adjustment] and  
press the 4 button.  
Composition Adjust.  
Start Adjustment  
Recall Previous Position  
To start adjusting the composition from  
the previous position, use the four-way  
Please note: depending on the  
controller (23) to select [Recall  
lens, adjusting the composition  
Previous Position] and use the four-way  
may cause vignetting  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
controller (45) to switch to O.  
6
Live View is displayed and the  
composition can be adjusted.  
3
Adjust the composition.  
0
0
0
The amount of compensation (the  
number of steps) is displayed at the top  
right of the screen.  
Adjust the composition ooff  
the image  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Available operations  
Four-way controller  
Moves the composition up, down, left or right.  
(2345)  
Adjust up to 24 steps (approximately ±1.5 mm) on  
the image sensor.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Adjusts the level of the composition when the  
amount of adjustment is less than 16 steps (±1.0  
mm) up or down, or to the left or right. Up to 8  
steps (approximately ±1°) can be adjusted.  
| button  
Resets the adjustment value.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
196  
4
Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to normal Live View and is ready to take a picture.  
• Shake Reduction and Horizon Correction are not available.  
• The saved adjustment value is reset when Live View is ended.  
• When using the composition adjustment function frequently, you can assign  
the function to the |/Y button. (p.249)  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
197  
Setting the Image Finishing Tone  
Take pictures with settings to suit for your creative photographic vision.  
Setting Custom Image  
Select the desired picture style from the following modes and enjoy taking  
pictures with a creative finishing tone.  
Image Tone  
Bright  
Image  
Saturation, hue and contrast are set relatively high to create a  
bright sharp image. (default setting)  
Natural  
Portrait  
Creates a natural look that is close to the actual color.  
Reproduces a healthy and bright skin tone.  
Increases color saturation, highlights shapes, and produces a  
vivid color image.  
Landscape  
Vibrant  
Muted  
Changes the color slightly to create an antique look.  
Reduces the saturation to create a soft look.  
6
Reduces the saturation and increases the contrast to create  
the look of an old picture.  
Bleach Bypass  
Creates a picture with strong image contrast as if taken with  
reversal film.  
Reversal Film  
Monochrome  
Takes pictures using a monochrome color filter.  
Image finishing tone is fixed to [Bright] and the parameters cannot be changed  
in the following conditions.  
- when the exposure mode is set to B (Green)  
- when Cross Processing is set  
1
Press the four-way controller (5) in Capture mode.  
The screen to select a custom image appears.  
The last image taken after the camera was turned on is displayed in the  
background.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
198  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select an image finishing tone.  
Bright  
R
M
B
Y
G
C
AE.L  
EX  
F
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to choose a parameter you want  
to change.  
Portrait  
R
M
Y
B
G
C
AE.L  
EX  
F
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Check  
OK  
The following parameters can be changed according to the selected  
image finishing tone.  
6
Image Tone  
Parameter  
Saturation: -4 to +4  
Hue: -4 to +4  
Bright/  
Natural/  
Portrait/  
Landscape/  
Vibrant  
High/Low Key Adj: -4 to +4  
Contrast: -4 to +4  
Sharpness: -4 to +4  
Saturation: -4 to +4  
Toning: Off/Green/Yellow/Orange/Red/Magenta/Purple/  
Blue/Cyan  
Muted/  
Bleach  
Bypass  
High/Low Key Adj: -4 to +4  
Contrast: -4 to +4  
Sharpness: -4 to +4  
Reversal Film Sharpness: -4 to +4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
199  
Image Tone  
Monochrome  
Parameter  
Filter Effect: None/Green/Yellow/Orange/Red/Magenta/  
Blue/Cyan/Infrared Filter  
Toning: Off/Green/Yellow/Orange/Red/Magenta/Purple/  
Blue/Cyan  
High/Low Key Adj: -4 to +4  
Contrast: -4 to +4  
Sharpness: -4 to +4  
4
Use the four-way controller (45) to change the setting.  
The background image changes according to the settings.  
You can visually check the saturation and hue with the radar chart.  
Available operations  
Front e-dial (R)  
Switches between enabling and disabling contrast  
settings.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Switches between [Sharpness], [Fine Sharpness]  
and [Extra Sharpness]. When set to [Fine  
Sharpness] or [Extra Sharpness], image outlines  
can be captured with more detail.  
6
| button  
Resets the set value.  
Main switch (|)  
Uses Digital Preview to preview the background  
image with the setting applied. (Not available during  
Live View.)  
L button  
Saves the background image. (Not available during  
Live View.)  
5
Press the 4 button.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
200  
Setting Cross Processing  
Cross processing is the procedure of deliberately processing a film in the  
wrong type of chemicals to create an image with different colors and  
contrast. This camera features digital cross processing, which is done  
internally.  
• When Cross Processing is set, the file format is fixed to [JPEG] and cannot  
be changed. You cannot use Cross Processing when the file format is set to  
[RAW] or [RAW+].  
• When Cross Processing is set, the following functions and operation are not  
available.  
- Multi-exposure  
- Extended Bracketing or HDR Capture (The function selected last is used.)  
- Changing the settings of White Balance and Custom Image  
1
Select [Cross Processing] in the [A Rec. Mode 2] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
6
When the exposure mode is set to C (Movie), select from [Movie] in the  
The [Cross Processing] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select an item and press  
Cross Processing  
OFF  
Cross Processing  
1
Save Settings  
2
the 4 button.  
3
1
Select from [Off], [Random], [Preset 1-3]  
and [Favorite 1-3].  
2
3
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the 3 button twice.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
201  
Saving the Cross Processing Setting of a Captured Image  
The outcome of cross processing varies each time a picture is taken. If you  
are able to take a cross processed image that you like, you can save the  
Cross Processing settings used in that image. A total of 3 Cross  
Processing settings can be saved for still pictures and movies.  
To save Cross Processing setting for movies, set from [Movie] in the [A Rec.  
Mode 4] menu with the mode dial set to C (Movie).  
1
Select [Save Settings] in Step 2 on p.200 and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The camera will search for cross processed images starting from the  
most recent image taken. (An hourglass icon is displayed while  
searching.) When a cross processed image is found, the screen to save  
the settings appears.  
If there are no cross processed images, the message [No cross  
processed image] appears.  
6
2
Turn the front e-dial (R) to  
select a cross processed image.  
1
100-0001  
Saves tthis image's Cross  
Processinng settings  
Save as Favorite 1  
Save as Favorite 2  
Save as Favorite 3  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select a number and  
press the 4 button.  
The setting of the selected image is saved to [Favorite 1 - 3].  
Press the 3 button twice to finish saving.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
202  
Storing Frequently Used Settings  
You can save the current camera settings in the A mode and easily  
retrieve them.  
The following settings can be stored.  
• Exposure Mode (other than B and C)  
• Slow Shutter Speed NR  
• D-Range Setting  
• Drive Mode  
Flash Mode/Flash Exposure Compensation • HDR Capture  
• White Balance  
• Sensitivity/ISO AUTO Setting  
• EV compensation value  
• Program Line  
• Custom Image  
• Cross Processing  
• Digital Filter  
• Shake Reduction/  
Horizon Correction  
• Extended Bracketing  
• JPEG Recorded Pixels  
• JPEG Quality  
• Lens Correction  
• Color Space  
• File Format  
• E-Dial Programming/  
Button Customization  
6
• RAW File Format  
• AF Settings  
• [A Custom Setting 1-4]  
menu settings  
• High-ISO NR  
The A mode cannot be set when the mode dial is set to B (Green) or C  
(Movie) mode.  
Saving the Settings  
Saves the settings as A mode. Up to five different settings can be  
saved.  
1
Make the necessary settings.  
2
Select [Save USER Mode] in the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Save USER Mode] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
203  
3
4
5
Press the four-way controller  
(5).  
Save USER Mode  
Save Settings  
Rename USER Mode  
Check Saved Settings  
Reset USER Mode  
MENU  
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select [A1] to [A5]  
and press the four-way controller  
(5).  
Save Settings  
USER  
USER  
USER  
USER  
USER  
1
2
3
4
5
USER1  
USER2  
USER3  
USER4  
USER5  
MENU  
Press the four-way controller (2)  
to select [Save] and press the  
4 button.  
USER  
1
Save Settings  
6
Saves current settings in  
USER1 custom mode  
The settings are saved and the screen  
that was displayed in Step 3 appears  
again.  
Save  
Cancel  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
Editing a Setting Name  
You can change the name of the A mode in which you saved settings.  
1
Select [Rename USER Mode] in Step 3 of “Saving the  
Settings” and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Rename USER Mode] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [A1] to  
[A5] and press the four-way controller (5).  
The text-entry screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
204  
3
Enter the text.  
USER  
1
Rename USER Mode  
Text selection  
cursor  
Up to 18 single-byte  
alphanumeric  
characters and  
symbols can be  
entered.  
Finish  
USER1  
Text input cursor  
Delete One Character  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Enter  
Available operations  
Four-way controller  
(2345)  
Moves the text selection cursor.  
Moves the text input cursor.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
| button  
Switches between upper and lower case letters.  
4 button  
Enters a character selected with the text selection  
cursor at the position of the text input cursor.  
i button  
Deletes a character at the position of the text  
input cursor.  
6
4
5
After entering the text, move the text selection cursor to  
[Finish] and press the 4 button.  
The name is changed.  
Repeat Steps 2 to 4 to change the names of other A modes.  
Press the 3 button.  
The camera returns to the [Save USER Mode] screen.  
Checking the Saved USER Settings  
1
Select [Check Saved Settings] in Step 3 of p.203 and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Check Saved Settings] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
205  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [A1] to  
[A5] and press the four-way controller (5).  
The current settings saved in the  
USER  
1
USER1  
selected A mode are displayed.  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2.0x5  
200-800  
P
ISO  
AUTO  
ISO  
NR  
AUTO  
ON  
AWB  
11  
G1 A1  
NR  
WB  
ON  
-
0.5  
BA  
1
1
+1.0  
JPEG 16M  
MENU  
AdobeRGB  
OK  
OK  
Press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the [Save USER Mode] screen.  
Using Saved USER Settings  
You can easily retrieve saved settings.  
6
1
Set the mode dial to A.  
The A mode guide appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(45) or the rear e-dial (S) to  
select [A1] to [A5].  
Use the four-way controller (23) to  
check the saved settings.  
USER  
1
USER1  
RAW  
P
RAW  
P
Tv  
Av  
AF Cancel AF  
The saved settings are retrieved.  
10/10/2012  
10:30AM  
3
Change the settings as necessary.  
The exposure mode can be changed in  
[Exposure Mode] of the [A Rec. Mode 1]  
menu.  
1
2
3
4
P
Sv  
Tv  
USER Mode  
Exposure Mode  
File Format  
Av  
TAv  
M
B
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
AF Settings  
Lens Correction  
X
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
206  
• The A mode guide appears for 30 seconds regardless of the [Guide  
Display] setting in the [R Set-up 1] menu.  
• [A1] to [A5] can also be selected  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR  
from [USER Mode] in the [A Rec. Mode  
1] menu.  
USER  
1
USER Mode  
Exposure Mode  
File Format  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
AF Settings  
USER  
2
• [USER Mode] and [Exposure Mode] are  
displayed in the [A Rec. Mode 1] menu  
only when the mode dial is set to A.  
• The settings changed in Step 3 are not  
saved as A mode settings. When the  
camera is turned off, settings return to the  
original saved settings.  
USER  
USER  
USER  
3
4
5
Lens Correction  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Resetting to Default Settings  
Resets the settings saved in A1 to A5 to the default settings.  
1
Select [Reset USER Mode] in Step 3 of p.203 and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
6
The [Reset USER Mode] screen appears.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [A1] to  
[A5] and press the four-way controller (5).  
Press the four-way controller (2)  
USER  
1
Reset USER Mode  
to select [Reset] and press the  
4 button.  
Resets USER1 custom mode  
to default settings and name  
The A mode settings return to the  
default values.  
Reset  
Cancel  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7 Playback Functions  
This chapter describes how to use the various playback  
functions in Playback mode.  
Playback Functions Operation ..........................208  
Enlarging Images ...............................................211  
Displaying Multiple Images ...............................212  
Rotating Images .................................................219  
Deleting Multiple Images ...................................220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
208  
Playback Functions Operation  
Make settings related to playing back images in the playback mode palette  
or [Q Playback] menu.  
Refer to “Using the Menus” (p.42) for details on how to use the menus.  
Playback Mode Palette Setting Items  
Press the four-way controller (3) in  
Image Rotation  
Playback mode to display the playback  
mode palette.  
You can display the playback mode palette  
even when a movie is paused.  
Rotates captured images.  
Useful for image playback on  
TV and other display devices  
OK  
MENU Exit  
OK  
Item  
Function  
Rotates images.  
Page  
7
s
Image Rotation  
Changes the color tone of images, or  
adds softening and slimming effects.  
D
Digital Filter  
Changes the number of recorded pixels  
and quality level of the captured image  
and saves it as a new file.  
n Resize  
Cuts out only the desired area of the  
picture and saves it as a new image.  
o Cropping  
Protects images from being accidentally  
erased.  
Z Protect  
u Slideshow  
K Save as Manual WB  
Plays back the images one after another. p.218  
You can copy the white balance settings  
of a captured image and save it as  
Manual White Balance.  
Converts RAW images to JPEG or TIFF  
format.  
h RAW Development  
Joins a number of images together and  
creates a new image with them.  
p Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
209  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Divides a movie and deletes unwanted  
segments.  
[ Movie Editing  
Sets the number of prints and whether to  
print the date on images saved on the  
SD Memory Card.  
r
DPOF  
Saves the GPS location information  
stored in the image as the destination for p.306  
Simple Navigation.  
U Save Destination  
*1 This cannot be performed when a movie is displayed.  
*2 This cannot be performed when a RAW image is displayed.  
*3 This can be performed only when RAW images are saved.  
*4 This can be performed only when a movie is displayed.  
*5 This can be performed only when an image with the GPS location information is saved.  
Playback Menu Setting Items  
You can perform the following settings in the [Q Playback] menu.  
Press the 3 button in Playback mode to display the [Q Playback 1]  
menu.  
Menu  
Item  
Slideshow  
Function  
Page  
7
Plays back the images one after another.  
You can set how images will be displayed p.217  
in the slideshow.  
Sets the initial magnification when  
enlarging images.  
Quick Zoom  
Q1  
Sets whether or not to display the Bright/  
Bright/Dark Area  
Dark Area warning during playback.  
Sets whether to rotate images shot with the  
camera held vertically when playing back.  
Auto Image Rotation  
Delete All Images  
You can delete all saved images at once. p.222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
210  
Setting the Playback Display Method  
You can set the initial magnification when enlarging images, whether to  
display the Bright/Dark Area warning, and whether to automatically rotate  
images that are shot with the camera held vertically in Playback mode.  
1
Select [Quick Zoom] in the [Q Playback 1] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the magnification and  
press the 4 button.  
1
Slideshow  
Quick Zoom  
Bright/Dark Area  
Auto Image Rotation  
Delete All Images  
Off  
x2  
x4  
x8  
x16  
x32  
Select from [Off] (default setting), [×2],  
[×4], [×8], [×16] or [×32].  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Bright/Dark  
Area] and use the four-way controller (45) to select O or  
P.  
7
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Auto Image  
Rotation] and use the four-way controller (45) to select  
O or P.  
During playback, the image is automatically rotated based on the  
rotation information when [23. Saving Rotation Info] in the [A Custom  
Setting 3] menu is set to [On] or image rotation information is saved  
O
in [Image Rotation] (p.219). (default setting)  
P
The image is not automatically rotated during playback.  
5
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
The Bright/Dark Area warning is not displayed in Detailed information display  
and RGB histogram display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
211  
Enlarging Images  
Images can be magnified up to 32 times in Playback mode.  
1
Use the four-way controller (45) to select an image in  
Playback mode.  
2
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to the  
right (toward y).  
100-0001  
The image enlarges at each click (1.2 times  
to 32 times).  
x4  
Available operations  
Rear e-dial (S) to the right (y) Enlarges the image (up to 32 times).  
/m button  
Rear e-dial (S) to the left (f) Reduces the image (up to 1.2 times).  
/| button  
7
Four-way controller (2345)  
4 button  
Changes the area to display.  
Returns to the original size.  
Front e-dial (R)  
Retains the magnification and the  
position of the magnified area and  
shows the previous/next image.  
M button  
Switches information display on/off.  
• The default setting for the first click (minimum magnification) is 1.2 times. You  
can change this in [Quick Zoom] of the [Q Playback 1] menu. (p.210)  
• The initial full display of vertical images is displayed with a magnification of  
0.675 times that of horizontal images, therefore, magnification at the first click  
starts at 1.0 times.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
212  
Displaying Multiple Images  
Multi-image Display Screen  
You can display 4, 9, 16, 36 or 81 thumbnail images on the monitor at the  
same time. The default setting is nine-image display.  
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to the left (toward f) in  
Playback mode.  
The multi-image display screen  
appears.  
Selection frame  
Up to nine thumbnail images are  
displayed at once.  
INFO  
100-0001  
7
Scroll bar  
Available operations  
Four-way controller Moves the selection frame.  
(2345)  
M button  
Displays the [Multi-img Display Setting] screen. Use  
the four-way controller (45) to select the number of  
images to display at the same time.  
Multi-img Display Setting  
Display Type  
OK  
MENU Cancel INFO  
OK  
(Display Type cannot be selected when developing  
multiple RAW images (p.240).)  
i button  
Selects multiple images and deletes them. (p.220)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
213  
2
Press the 4 button.  
A full screen display of the selected image appears.  
Icons such as C and ? are not displayed with thumbnail images for 81-image  
display.  
Displaying Images by Folder  
Images will be grouped and displayed by folder in which they are saved.  
1
In the multi-image display screen, turn the rear e-dial  
(S) to the left (toward f) again.  
The folder display screen appears.  
2
Select the folder you want to  
display.  
50  
100  
103  
101  
104  
102  
105  
The number of images saved in the  
selected folder appears at the top right of  
the screen.  
7
_
100 0105  
Available operations  
Four-way controller Moves the selection frame.  
(2345)  
i button  
Deletes the selected folder and all the images in it. (p.221)  
3
Press the 4 button.  
The multi-image display screen for the selected folder appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
214  
Displaying Images by the Shooting Date  
(Calendar Display)  
Images will be grouped and displayed by the shooting date.  
1
In the multi-image display screen, press the M button.  
The [Multi-img Display Setting] screen appears.  
2
Press the M button again.  
The calendar display screen appears.  
Number of images shot on this date  
Only the dates when pictures were taken  
are displayed.  
2/5  
2012.10  
WED  
17  
19  
29  
FRI  
MON  
2012. 11  
THU  
SUN  
WED  
SAT  
8
11  
14  
17  
Delete  
INFO  
Shooting  
date  
Thumbnail  
7
Available operations  
Four-way controller (23) Selects a shooting date.  
Four-way controller (45) Selects an image taken on the selected  
shooting date.  
Rear e-dial (S) to the  
Displays the selected image. Turn to the left  
right (y)  
(f) to return to the calendar display.  
M button  
The camera returns to the multi-image display  
screen.  
i button  
Deletes selected images.  
3
Press the 4 button.  
A full screen display of the selected image appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
215  
Joining Multiple Images (Index)  
Join a number of images together and display them as an index print. You  
can select the images to include in the index print or have them randomly-  
arranged.  
This function is not available for movies.  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Playback mode.  
The playback mode palette appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select p (Index)  
and press the 4 button.  
The [Index] screen appears.  
3
4
Press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a layout and press the  
Index  
Layout  
Images  
Backgrnd.  
Selection  
4 button.  
7
Youcanselect  
o
(Thumbnail),  
(Random2),  
(Bubble).  
p
(Square),  
q
s
(Random1),  
(Random3) or  
r
p
Create an index image  
Images are displayed according to the file  
number (from the smallest number) for  
are displayed in random order for other layouts.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
o
, and  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Images] and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select the number of  
images and press the 4 button.  
You can select 12, 24 or 36 images.  
When the number of saved images is smaller than the number selected,  
empty spaces will appear when [Layout] is set to o (Thumbnail) and  
some images may be duplicated for other layouts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
216  
7
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Backgrnd.]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
8
Use the four-way controller (23) to select the  
background color and press the 4 button.  
You can select a white or black background.  
9
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Selection] and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
10 Use the four-way controller (23) to select a type of image  
selection and press the 4 button.  
Picks images automatically from all of the images  
saved.  
u
w
Auto  
Individually select images you want to include in  
the index. Continue by selecting [Select image(s)]  
and select the individual images.  
Manual  
Picks images automatically from the folder  
selected. Continue by selecting [Select a folder]  
and select the folder.  
x
Folder name  
7
11 Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Create an  
index image] and press the 4 button.  
The index image is created and a confirmation screen appears.  
12 Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save] or  
[Reshuffle] and press the 4 button.  
Save  
The index image is saved as a P and C file.  
Reselects the images to be included in the index and  
displays a new index image. However, if o (Thumbnail)  
is selected for [Layout], this item is not displayed.  
Reshuffle  
After the index image is saved, the camera returns to Playback mode  
and the index image is displayed.  
Processing may take a while when creating an index image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
217  
Playing Back Images Continuously  
You can play back all images saved on your SD Memory Card  
successively in the slideshow.  
Setting the Slideshow Display  
Sets how images will be displayed during the Slideshow.  
1
Select [Slideshow] in the [Q Playback 1] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The screen to make the slideshow settings appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select an item you want  
Slideshow starts  
to change.  
Start  
Interval  
Screen Effect  
Repeat Playback  
3sec.  
The following items can be changed.  
7
OK  
MENU  
OK  
Item  
Interval  
Description  
Setting  
Select an image display  
interval.  
3sec. (default setting)/  
5sec./10sec./30sec.  
Screen  
Effect  
Select a transition effect when Off (default setting)/Fade/  
the next image is displayed.  
Wipe/Stripe  
Set whether to start the  
slideshow again from the  
beginning after the last image is  
displayed.  
Repeat  
Playback  
P (default setting)/O  
3
Press the four-way controller (5) and use the four-way  
controller (23) to change the setting and press the 4  
button.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
218  
Starting the Slideshow  
1
Select [Start] in Step 2 on p.217 and press the 4 button.  
Or, select u (Slideshow) in the playback mode palette  
and press the 4 button.  
The start screen is displayed and the  
slideshow begins.  
Start  
OK  
Available operations  
4 button  
Pauses playback. Press again to resume  
playback.  
Four-way controller (4)  
Shows the previous image.  
Shows the next image.  
Four-way controller (5)  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
7
Slideshow stops and the single image display reappears.  
After slideshow ends, the camera returns to the single image display  
even if you do not press the four-way controller (3).  
For movies, only the first frame is displayed and then the next image is  
displayed after the set interval has elapsed. To play back a movie during a  
slideshow, press the 4 button while the first frame is displayed. When the  
movie playback is finished, the slideshow will resume.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
219  
Rotating Images  
When pictures are taken with this camera held vertically, the vertical  
position sensor activates and rotation information is added to the image to  
enable playback with the correct image orientation. You can change the  
rotation information and save the image using the following procedure.  
• When [23. Saving Rotation Info] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu is set to  
[Off], the image rotation information is not saved when shooting.  
• When [Auto Image Rotation] (p.210) in the [Q Playback 1] menu is set to O  
(On), an image with rotation information is automatically rotated during  
playback.  
• You cannot change the image rotation information in the following conditions.  
- when the image is protected  
- when the image rotation information tag is not saved with the image  
- when [Auto Image Rotation] (p.210) in the [Q Playback 1] menu is set to  
P (Off)  
• Movie files cannot be rotated.  
1
Select the image you want to rotate in Playback mode.  
7
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
3
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select s (Image  
Rotation) and press the 4 button.  
The selected image is rotated in 90° increments and the four thumbnail  
images are displayed.  
4
Use the four-way controller  
(2345) to select a desired  
rotation direction and press the  
4 button.  
The image rotation information is saved.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
220  
Deleting Multiple Images  
You can delete multiple images at once. Be aware that deleted images  
cannot be restored.  
Deleting Selected Images  
You can delete multiple images in the multi-image display at once.  
• Protected images cannot be deleted.  
• You can select up to 100 images at a time.  
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to the left (toward f) in  
Playback mode.  
The multi-image display screen appears.  
2
Press the i button.  
The screen to select the images to delete is displayed.  
The screen temporarily changes to 36-image display when [Multi-img  
Display Setting] (p.212) is set to 81-image display.  
7
3
Select the images to delete.  
OK  
MENU  
Delete  
Available operations  
Four-way controller Moves the selection frame.  
(2345)  
4 button  
Adds O and selects an image. Press again to return  
to P. Protected images (Z) cannot be selected.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Displays a full screen display of the image selected with the  
selection frame. When the image is displayed full screen, press the  
four-way controller (45) to display the previous or next image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
221  
4
5
Press the i button.  
The delete confirmation screen appears.  
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Select &  
Delete] and press the 4 button.  
The selected images are deleted.  
Deleting a Folder  
You can delete a selected folder and all the images in it.  
1
Turn the rear e-dial (S) two clicks to the left (toward f)  
in Playback mode.  
The folder display screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(2345) to select a folder to  
delete and press the i button.  
The delete folder confirmation screen  
appears.  
50  
100  
103  
101  
104  
102  
105  
7
_
100 0105  
3
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Delete] and  
press the 4 button.  
The selected folder and all images in it are deleted.  
The confirmation screen appears when  
there are protected images. Use the four-  
3image(s)  
Protected images are found  
way controller (23) to select [Delete All]  
or [Leave All] and press the 4 button.  
When [Delete All] is selected, protected  
Delete All  
images are also deleted.  
Leave All  
OK  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
222  
Deleting All Images  
You can delete all saved images at once.  
1
Select [Delete All Images] in the [Q Playback 1] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The confirmation screen for deleting all images is displayed.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Delete All  
Images] and press the 4 button.  
All images are deleted.  
The confirmation screen appears when there are protected images. Use  
the four-way controller (23) to select [Delete All] or [Leave All] and  
press the 4 button.  
When [Delete All] is selected, protected images are also deleted.  
Protecting Images from Deletion (Protect)  
7
You can protect images from being accidentally deleted.  
Even protected images are deleted if the inserted SD Memory Card is  
formatted.  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Playback mode.  
The playback mode palette appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select  
Z (Protect) and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select the protection setting method is displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
223  
3
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Single Image] or [All  
Images] and press the 4  
button.  
Single Image  
All Images  
If you selected [All Images], proceed to  
Step 5.  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
4
5
Use the four-way controller (45) to select an image to  
protect.  
Press the four-way controller (2)  
100-0105  
to select [Protect] and press the  
4 button.  
Select [Unprotect] to cancel the  
protection of the image.  
Protect  
Unprotect  
The image is protected and the Y icon  
appears at the top right of the screen.  
OK  
MENU Exit  
OK  
Repeat Steps 4 and 5 to protect other  
images.  
7
If you selected [All Images] in Step 3, the camera returns to the playback  
mode.  
6
Press the 3 button.  
The camera returns to Playback mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
224  
Connecting the Camera to an AV  
Device  
You can connect the camera to a TV or other device with a video input  
terminal or HDMI terminal and play back images.  
• If you intend to use the camera continuously for a long period, use of the AC  
adapter kit (optional) is recommended. (p.52)  
For an AV device with multiple video input terminals, check the operating manual of  
the AV device, and select a suitable video input terminal for connecting the camera.  
• You cannot output both composite and HDMI video signals at the same time.  
• You cannot adjust the volume on the camera while the camera is connected  
to the AV device. Adjust the volume on the AV device.  
• If you want to view a movie on an external monitor while recording it, connect  
the camera to an AV device with a mini HDMI terminal. You cannot output a  
movie using the video input terminal while recording.  
Connecting the Camera to a Video Input Terminal  
Use the provided AV cable I-AVC7 to connect the camera to a device with  
a video input terminal.  
7
1
Turn the AV device and camera off.  
2
Open the terminal cover, face the arrow on the AV cable  
toward the 2 mark on the camera, and connect the cable  
to the PC/AV terminal.  
3
Connect the other end of the AV cable to the video input  
terminal on the AV device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
225  
4
Turn the AV device and camera on.  
The camera turns on in video mode, and the camera information is  
displayed on the screen of the connected AV device.  
Even if you used an external microphone to record movie sound in stereo,  
monaural sound is played back.  
Selecting the Video Output Format  
When the hometown is set at the time of initial setting (p.60), the video  
output format is set in accordance with that region. Depending on the  
country or region, images may fail to be played back with the set video  
output format. If this happens, change the video output format setting.  
1
Select [Video Out] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [NTSC] or [PAL] and  
1
2
3
4
Brightness Level  
0
LCD Color Tuning  
Video Out  
HDMI Out  
press the 4 button.  
7
NTSC  
PAL  
USB Connection  
Folder Name  
MSC  
Date  
Create New Folder  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
The video output format differs depending on the region. When you set [Setting  
the Time] in the World Time setting (p.253) to X (Destination), the video output  
setting changes to the video output format for that city. Refer to “List of World  
Time Cities” (p.255) for cities that can be selected as a hometown or  
destination.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
226  
Connecting the Camera to an HDMI Terminal  
Use a commercially available HDMI cable to connect the camera to a  
device with an HDMI terminal.  
1
Turn the AV device and camera off.  
2
Open the terminal cover and connect the HDMI cable to  
the mini HDMI terminal.  
7
3
4
Connect the other end of the HDMI cable to the HDMI input  
terminal on the AV device.  
Turn the AV device and camera on.  
The camera turns on in HDMI mode, and the camera information is  
displayed on the screen of the connected AV device.  
• The camera has a mini HDMI terminal (Type C). Use a commercially  
available HDMI cable that matches your AV device.  
• Nothing is displayed on the camera monitor during HDMI output.  
• If you used an external microphone to record movie sound in stereo, the  
sound is played back in stereo.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
227  
Selecting the HDMI Output Format  
By default, the maximum resolution is automatically selected to suit the AV  
device and camera. However, if it fails to play back images properly,  
change the HDMI output format setting.  
1
Select [HDMI Out] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the HDMI output format.  
1
2
3
4
Brightness Level  
0
LCD Color Tuning  
Video Out  
HDMI Out  
USB Connection  
Folder Name  
Create New Folder  
NTSC  
Auto  
1080i  
720p  
The maximum resolution that  
the AV device and camera  
support is automatically  
selected. (default setting)  
Auto  
480p  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
1080i  
720p  
480p  
1920×1080i  
1280×720p  
720×480p  
*1 This depends on the selected video output format; [480p] for NTSC and [576p]  
(720×576p) for PAL.  
7
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
• When the HDMI output format is set to [1080i] or [720p], the display of the AV  
device may appear with a screen design that differs from that displayed on  
the camera.  
• The Bright/Dark Area warning is not displayed during Live View.  
• When the exposure mode is set to C (Movie), the output format is fixed to  
[480p] regardless of the HDMI output format setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
228  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8 Processing Images  
This chapter describes how to process pictures taken and  
edit RAW images.  
Changing the Image Size ...................................230  
Developing RAW Images ...................................238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
230  
Changing the Image Size  
Changes the number of recorded pixels and quality level of the image, and  
saves the image as a new file.  
Changing the Number of Recorded Pixels and  
Quality Level (Resize)  
Changes the number of recorded pixels and quality level of the selected  
image and saves it as a new image.  
• Only JPEG images captured with this camera can be resized.  
• Images already resized to S or Z with this camera cannot be resized.  
1
Select an image to resize in Playback mode.  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select  
n (Resize) and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select the recorded pixels and quality level appears.  
8
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select the desired image size.  
You can select one of the image sizes  
starting from one size smaller than that of  
the original image. The selectable sizes  
16M  
10M  
vary according to the original image size.  
OK  
MENU  
5
Press the four-way controller (3) and use the four-way  
controller (45) to select the quality level.  
You can select Z, C, D or E.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
231  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The resized image is saved as a new image.  
Cutting Out Part of the Image (Cropping)  
Cuts out only the desired area of the selected image and saves it as a new  
image. The aspect ratio can also be changed.  
• Only JPEG and RAW images captured with this camera can be cropped.  
• Images already resized to S or Z with this camera cannot be cropped.  
1
Select an image to crop in Playback mode.  
2
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
8
3
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select  
o (Cropping) and press the 4 button.  
The cropping frame to specify the size and position of the area to crop  
appears on the screen.  
4
Specify the size and position of  
the area to crop by using the  
cropping frame.  
MENU  
OK  
INFO  
3:2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
232  
Available operations  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Changes the size of the cropping frame.  
Moves the cropping frame.  
Four-way controller  
(2345)  
M button  
Changes the aspect ratio. Select from [3:2], [4:3],  
[16:9] or [1:1]. The image can also be rotated  
from -45° to +45° in increments of 1°.  
3:2  
0°  
Aspect Ratio  
Image Rotation  
MENU  
| button  
Rotates the cropping frame in 90° increments.  
| appears only when the cropping frame can  
be rotated.  
5
6
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
8
The cropped image is saved as a new image.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
233  
Processing Images with Digital  
Filters  
You can edit captured images using digital filters.  
The following filters are available.  
Filter Name  
Effect  
Parameter  
Shading Level: Low/Medium/High  
Creates an image that looks  
Toy Camera as though it was shot with a Blur: Low/Medium/High  
toy camera.  
Tone Break: Red/Green/Blue/Yellow  
Toning (B-A): 7 levels  
Creates an image with the  
look of an old photo.  
Retro  
Frame Composite: None/Thin/  
Medium/Thick  
High  
Contrast  
Enhances the contrast in  
the image.  
+1 to +5  
Contrast: Low/Medium/High  
Scratch Effect: OFF/ON  
Creates an image that looks as  
though it was drawn with a pencil.  
Sketch Filter  
Intensity: Low/Medium/High  
Creates an image that looks  
as though it was painted.  
Water Color  
Pastel  
Saturation: OFF/Low/Medium/High  
Creates an image that looks as  
though it was drawn with a crayon.  
Low/Medium/High  
Lessens the tone of theimage  
Posterization to create an image that looks +1 to +5  
as though it was hand-drawn.  
8
In-Focus Plane: -3 to +3  
In-Focus Width: Narrow/Middle/Wide  
Blurs part of the image to  
create a fake miniature  
scene.  
Miniature  
In-Focus Plane Angle: Horizon/  
Vertical/Positive Slope/Negative Slope  
Blur: Low/Medium/High  
Brightness: -8 to +8  
Saturation: -3 to +3  
Hue: -3 to +3  
Base  
Parameter  
Adj  
Adjusts the parameters to  
create the desired image.  
Contrast: -3 to +3  
Sharpness: -3 to +3  
Filter Effect: OFF/Red/Green/Blue/  
Infrared Filter  
Creates a monochrome  
Monochrome image such as a black-and-  
white photo.  
Toning (B-A): 7 levels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
234  
Filter Name  
Color  
Effect  
Parameter  
Color: Red/Magenta/Blue/Cyan/  
Green/Yellow  
Adds a color filter to the  
image.  
Color Density: Light/Standard/Dark  
Extracted Color 1: Red/Magenta/  
Blue/Cyan/Green/Yellow  
Extracts one or two specific  
colors and makes the rest of  
the image black and white.  
Extractable Range of Color 1: +1 to +5  
Extract  
Color  
Extracted Color 2: OFF/Red/  
Magenta/Blue/Cyan/Green/Yellow  
Extractable Range of Color 2: +1 to +5  
Soft Focus: Low/Medium/High  
Creates an image with a  
soft focus throughout the  
image.  
Soft  
Shadow Blur: OFF/ON  
Shape: Cross/Star/Snow Crystal/  
Heart/Musical Note  
For taking pictures of night  
scenes or lights reflected on  
water with a special  
sparkling look by adding  
extra glitter to the highlights.  
Effect Density: Small/Medium/Large  
Size: Small/Medium/Large  
Angle: 0°/30°/45°/60°  
Starburst  
Fish-eye  
Creates an image that looks  
as though it was shot with a Low/Medium/High  
fish-eye lens.  
Changes the horizontal and  
-8 to +8  
Slim  
8
vertical ratio of images.  
Creates animage that looks like  
Low/Medium/High  
HDR  
a high dynamic range image.  
High Contrast: OFF/+1 to +5  
Soft Focus: OFF/+1 to +3  
Tone Break: OFF/Red/Green/Blue/  
Yellow  
Shading Type: 6 types  
Shading Level: -3 to +3  
Distortion Type: 3 types  
Custom  
Filter  
Customize and save a filter  
to your own preferences.  
Distortion Level: OFF/Low/Medium/  
High  
Invert Color: OFF/ON  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
235  
Only JPEG and RAW images captured with this camera can be edited using  
the Digital Filter.  
Applying the Digital Filter  
1
Select an image for applying the digital filter in Playback  
mode.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The playback mode palette appears.  
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select D (Digital  
Filter) and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select a filter appears.  
4
Use the four-way controller  
(2345) to select a filter and  
100-0001  
Toy Camera  
press the 4 button.  
After selecting a filter, you can check the  
effect on the screen.  
8
You can turn the front e-dial (R) to  
select a different image.  
OK  
MENU Exit  
OK  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a parameter and the  
four-way controller (45) to  
adjust the value.  
100-0001  
Red  
OK  
MENU  
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
236  
7
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Use filters in  
Continue selecting filters?  
combination] or [Save as].  
Select [Use filters in combination] when  
you want to apply additional filters to the  
same image.  
Use filters in combination  
Save as  
Cancel  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
8
Press the 4 button.  
If [Use filters in combination] was selected, the screen that was displayed  
in Step 4 appears again.  
If [Save as] was selected, the filter-processed image is saved as a new  
image.  
Up to 20 filters, including a digital filter used during shooting (p.143), can be  
combined to the same image.  
Recreating Filter Effects  
Retrieves the setting of an image with filter effects and applies the same  
filter effects to other images.  
8
1
Select a filter-processed image in Playback mode.  
2
Select D (Digital Filter) in the playback mode palette and  
press the 4 button.  
3
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Recreating filter  
Applying the digital filter  
effects] and press the 4  
Recreating filter effects  
button.  
Searching for the original image  
The history of the filter usage for the  
selected image appears.  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
237  
4
To check the parameter details,  
press the M button.  
100-0001  
Reappliees followwing digital filter  
effectss from prreviouss image  
You can check the filter parameters.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
10.  
11.  
12.  
13.  
14.  
15.  
16.  
17. - -  
18. - -  
19. - -  
20. - -  
Press the M button again to return to  
the previous screen.  
OK  
OK  
MENU  
INFO Details  
5
6
Press the 4 button.  
The image selection screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select an image for applying  
the same filter effects and press  
the 4 button.  
100-0001  
Performs ddigital filter  
processinng to this image  
You can only select an image that has not  
been processed with a filter.  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
7
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The filter-processed image is saved as a new image.  
8
If [Searching for the original image] is selected in Step 3, the original image  
prior to digital filter application can be retrieved. If the original image is no  
longer stored on the SD Memory Card, the message [Original image, prior to  
digital filter application, is not found] appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
238  
Developing RAW Images  
You can convert captured RAW images into JPEG or TIFF images.  
Only RAW images captured with this camera can be edited. RAW images and  
JPEG images captured with other cameras cannot be edited on this camera.  
Developing One RAW Image  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Playback mode.  
The playback mode palette appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select h (RAW  
Development) and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select a development method is displayed.  
3
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Developing a Single  
Image] and press the 4 button.  
Developing a Single Image  
8
The parameters recorded in the image file  
Developing Multiple Images  
appear.  
Proceed to Step 6 if you do not need to  
change the parameters.  
OK  
MENU  
OK  
If there are no images that can be  
processed, [No image can be processed] appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
239  
4
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to choose a parameter you  
want to change.  
16M  
RAW  
JPEG  
File Format  
ISO  
NR  
You can turn the front e-dial (R) to  
select a different image.  
sRGB  
OK  
MENU  
100-0001  
The following parameters can be changed.  
Parameter  
File Format  
Value  
Page  
-
JPEG/TIFF  
p (4928×3264)/J (3936×2624)/  
P (3072×2048)/i (1728×1152)  
Recorded Pixels  
Z (Premium) / C (Best) / D  
(Better) / E (Good)  
Quality Level  
Bright/Natural/Portrait/Landscape/  
Custom Image  
Vibrant/Muted/Bleach Bypass/Reversal p.197  
Film/Monochrome  
F (Auto)/G (Daylight)/H (Shade)/  
^ (Cloudy)/JD (Fluorescent Light  
Daylight Color)/JN (Fluorescent Light  
Daylight White)/JW (Fluorescent Light  
Cool White)/ JL (Fluorescent Light  
White Balance  
Warm White)/I (Tungsten Light)/  
L (Flash)/f/K (Manual)/K (Color  
Temperature)  
8
Sensitivity  
-2.0 to +2.0  
-
High-ISO NR  
Auto/Off/Low/Medium/High  
Off/Low/Medium/High  
Off/On  
Shadow Correction  
Distortion Correction  
Lat-Chromatic-Ab Adj  
Color Space  
Off/On  
sRGB/AdobeRGB  
*1 This cannot be set when [File Format] is set to [TIFF]. (The setting is fixed to p.)  
*2 This cannot be set for RAW images taken in Multi-exposure mode.  
*3 This can be selected only when a compatible lens is attached. (p.297)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
240  
5
Use the four-way controller (45) to change the value.  
For File Format, Recorded Pixels, and Quality Level, press the four-way  
controller (5) and use the four-way controller (23) to select an item.  
For Custom Image and White Balance, press the four-way controller (5)  
to display the setting screen.  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The RAW image is developed and saved as a new image.  
8
9
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Continue] or  
[Exit].  
Select [Continue] to edit other images.  
Press the 4 button.  
If you select [Continue] in Step 8, the screen for selecting the parameters  
in Step 4 appears again.  
8
Developing Multiple RAW Images  
You can develop multiple RAW images with the same settings.  
1
Select [Developing Multiple Images] in Step 3 on p.238 and  
press the 4 button.  
The multi-image display screen appears.  
Refer to p.212 for details on operations during the multi-image display.  
2
3
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select the RAW  
images to be developed and press the 4 button.  
Press the L button.  
The development confirmation screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
241  
4
5
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Develop images as  
shot] or [Develop images with  
modified settings].  
Develop images as shot  
Develop images with  
modified settings  
To change parameters, select [Develop  
images with modified settings].  
OK  
MENU  
RAW  
OK  
Use the four-way controller  
(2345) to set [File Format],  
[Recorded Pixels] and [Quality  
Level].  
JPEG  
JPEG  
File Format  
16M  
If [TIFF] is selected, the [Recorded Pixels]  
and [Quality Level] settings are not  
available.  
OK  
MENU  
When [Develop images with modified  
settings] is selected, refer to p.239 to change other parameters. All images  
are developed with the same settings.  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
8
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save as] and  
press the 4 button.  
The selected RAW images are developed and saved as new images.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
242  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9 Changing Additional  
Settings  
This chapter describes how to change additional settings.  
Language ............................................................252  
Setting the Folder/File Number .........................263  
Selecting the Power Settings ............................266  
Setting the DPOF Settings .................................271  
Sensor (Pixel Mapping) ......................................273  
(Memory) .............................................................274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
244  
How to Operate the Set-up Menu  
Perform general settings related to the camera in the [R Set-up] menu.  
Refer to “Using the Menus” (p.42) for details on how to use the menus.  
Set-up Menu Setting Items  
Perform the following settings in the [R Set-up 1-4] menus.  
Press the 3 button in Capture/Playback mode and use the four-way  
controller (45) to display the [R Set-up 1-4] menus.  
Menu  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Changes the language in which menus  
and messages appear.  
Language/u  
Date Adjustment  
Sets the date format and time.  
Sets the display of the local date and time  
of the specified city so they can be  
displayed on the monitor in addition to the  
present location when traveling overseas.  
World Time  
R1  
Sets the text size of an item selected on  
the respective menu screens.  
Text Size  
Beep  
Switches the beep tone on/off.  
Sets whether to display indicators on the  
monitor.  
Guide Display  
9
Sets the display color of the status screen  
and control panel.  
Status Screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
245  
Menu  
Item  
Function  
Page  
Brightness Level  
LCD Color Tuning  
Changes the brightness of the monitor.  
Adjusts the color of the monitor.  
Sets the output format when connecting  
to an AV device with a video input  
terminal.  
Video Out  
HDMI Out  
Sets the HDMI output format when  
connecting to an AV device with an HDMI p.227  
terminal.  
R2  
Sets the USB connection mode when  
USB Connection  
Folder Name  
connecting to a computer.  
Sets the naming system of the folder for  
storing images.  
Creates a new folder on the SD Memory  
Card.  
Create New Folder  
File Name  
Sets the method used to assign file  
names for images.  
Copyright  
Information  
Sets the photographer and copyright  
information embedded in Exif.  
R3  
Sets the time until the camera turns off  
automatically.  
Auto Power Off  
Sets the battery to use when the optional  
Select Battery  
Reset  
battery grip is attached.  
Resets all settings.  
Maps out and corrects any defective  
pixels in the CMOS sensor.  
Pixel Mapping  
Detects dust adhering to the CMOS  
sensor.  
9
Dust Alert  
R4  
Cleans the CMOS sensor using ultrasonic  
vibrations.  
Dust Removal  
Locks the mirror in the up position for  
cleaning the CMOS sensor with a blower.  
Sensor Cleaning  
Format  
Formats an SD Memory Card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
246  
Formatting the SD Memory Card  
Use this camera to format (initialize) an SD Memory Card that is unused  
or has been used on other cameras or digital devices.  
Formatting deletes all the data saved on the SD Memory Card.  
• Do not remove the SD Memory Card while formatting. The card may be  
damaged and become unusable.  
• Formatting deletes all data, both protected and unprotected. Be aware.  
1
Select [Format] in the [R Set-up 4] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The [Format] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2)  
to select [Format].  
Format  
All data will be deleted  
Format  
Cancel  
OK  
OK  
3
Press the 4 button.  
Formatting starts.  
9
When formatting is completed, the screen that was displayed before  
selecting the menu appears again.  
When an SD Memory Card is formatted, the volume label assigned to the card  
is “K-5 II”. When this camera is connected to a computer, the SD Memory Card  
is recognized as a removable disk with the name “K-5 II”. (p.280)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
247  
Customizing Buttons and Dials  
You can set the functions for when the e-dials are turned, when the  
|/Y button, = button or Preview dial is operated, and when the  
shutter release button is pressed halfway.  
The current functions assigned to the buttons/dials can be checked with  
guide display. (p.25)  
Setting the Functions for the E-dials  
For each exposure mode, you can set the functions for when the front and  
rear e-dials and | button are operated.  
1
Select [E-Dial Programming] in the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [E-Dial Programming 1] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select an exposure  
mode.  
1
2
E-Dial Programming  
Tv  
- -  
Av  
ISO  
- -  
P
P
- -  
- -  
- -  
Sv  
Tv  
Av  
TAv  
Tv  
- -  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to display the  
[E-Dial Programming 2] screen.  
Av  
Av  
P
LINE  
Tv  
MENU  
9
3
4
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The screen for the selected exposure mode appears.  
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select a function.  
Exposure Mode  
P
P
P
Tv  
Av  
Av  
Tv  
- -  
P
SHIFT  
P
P
LINE  
LINE  
P
SHIFT  
You can perform the following settings for  
each exposure mode.  
- -  
- -  
- -  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
248  
Exposure  
Mode  
R Front E-dial  
S Rear E-dial  
| Button  
b
c
c
b
}e  
}e  
m
eSHIFT  
m
eLINE  
e
eSHIFT  
eLINE  
o
o
eSHIFT  
o
m
o
eSHIFT  
o
m
eLINE  
K
eLINE  
o
b
b
b
m
b
c
m
b
b
o
b
o AUTO  
o
o AUTO  
c
c
m
c
c
m
o
c
c
o AUTO  
o AUTO  
9
o
c
b
c
b
eLINE  
L
/a  
bSHIFT  
cSHIFT  
c
c
o
c
p
c
o
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
249  
Exposure  
Mode  
R Front E-dial  
S Rear E-dial  
| Button  
c
c
o
c
c
o
M
cSHIFT  
c
c
m
c
m
C
c
cSHIFT  
b: Change shutter speed c: Change aperture value o: Change sensitivity  
m: Adjust EV compensation value }e: Return to e eLINE: Program line  
eSHIFT: Program shift –: Not available  
5
6
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 2 appears again.  
Repeat Steps 2 to 6 to change the settings of other exposure modes.  
7
Press the 3 button twice.  
9
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
Setting the Functions for the Buttons  
You can set the functions for when the |/Y button, = button, or  
Preview dial (main switch |) is operated, and when the shutter release  
button is pressed halfway.  
1
Select [Button Customization] in the [A Rec. Mode 5]  
menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Button Customization] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
250  
2
3
Use the four-way controller  
(23) to select an item to set a  
function to and press the four-  
way controller (5).  
Button Customization  
RAW/Fx Button  
AF Button  
Preview Dial  
Shutter Button Half Press  
The screen to set the function for the  
selected item is displayed.  
MENU  
Press the four-way controller (5) and use the four-way  
controller (23) to select a function.  
The following functions can be assigned to each button.  
Button  
Setting  
Function  
Page  
One Push File  
Format  
Temporarily changes the file  
format.  
Sets the Exposure  
Bracketing.  
Exposure Bracketing  
Digital Preview  
Displays the Digital Preview. p.120  
Displays the Electronic Level  
Electronic Level  
|/Y  
button  
on the monitor.  
Displays the [Composition  
Composition Adjust.  
Adjust.] screen.  
Displays the Electronic  
Compass, Simple Navigation,  
GPS  
or ASTROTRACER screen  
when the optional GPS unit is  
attached to the camera.  
9
The autofocus system  
operates.  
Enable AF  
Cancel AF  
= button  
Disables autofocus with the  
shutter release button while  
the button is pressed.  
Displays the Optical Preview  
when the main switch is  
turned to the preview position  
(|).  
Optical Preview  
Digital Preview  
Preview  
Dial  
Displays the Digital Preview  
when the main switch is  
turned to the preview position  
(|).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
251  
Button  
Setting  
Enable AF  
Function  
Page  
The autofocus system  
operates.  
The autofocus system does  
not operate when the shutter  
release button is pressed  
halfway.  
Shutter  
release  
button  
Off  
-
pressed  
halfway  
Only during Live View, the  
autofocus system does not  
operate when the shutter  
release button is pressed  
halfway.  
Off  
(Live View only)  
4
5
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button three times.  
The camera is ready to take a picture.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
252  
Setting the Beep, Date and Time, and  
Display Language  
Setting the Beep  
You can turn the camera operation beep on or off, or change its volume.  
By default, all available items are set to O (On), and the volume level is  
set to [3].  
The following items can be set.  
• In-focus  
• AE-L (AE Lock operation sound)  
• Self-timer  
• Remote Control  
• Mirror Up  
• One Push File Format (operation sound when [One Push File Format]  
is assigned to the |/Y button)  
• Press OK for 1 sec. (operation sound when Change AF point is  
enabled or disabled)  
1
Select [Beep] in the [R Set-up 1] menu and press the four-  
way controller (5).  
The [Beep 1] screen appears.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (3) and use the four-way  
controller (45) to adjust the volume.  
Select from six levels. When set to Z (0), you can turn all the beeps off.  
9
Use the four-way controller  
1
2
Beep  
(23) to choose an item.  
Volume  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to display the  
In-focus  
AE-L  
[Beep 2] screen.  
Self-timer  
Remote Control  
Mirror Up  
MENU  
4
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
253  
5
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Changing the Date and Time Display  
You can change the initial date and time settings, and set their display  
formats. Choose [mm/dd/yy], [dd/mm/yy] or [yy/mm/dd] for the date  
display format, and [12h] (12-hour display) or [24h] (24-hour display) for  
the time display format.  
Set in [Date Adjustment] in the [R Set-up 1] menu.  
Setting the World Time  
The date and time selected in “Initial Settings” (p.60) serve as the date and  
time of your present location.  
Setting the destination in [World Time] enables you to display the local  
date and time on the monitor when traveling overseas.  
1
Select [World Time] in the [R Set-up 1] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [World Time] screen appears.  
9
2
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select X (Destination) or W  
World Time  
Setting the Time  
(Hometown) for [Setting the  
Time].  
Destination  
:
16 00  
London  
Hometown  
New York  
This setting is reflected on the date and  
time that appear in the guide display and  
control panel.  
:
10 00  
MENU  
3
Press the four-way controller (3).  
The selection frame moves to [X Destination].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
254  
4
5
Press the four-way controller (5).  
The [X Destination] screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to select a destination city.  
Destination  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to change the  
region.  
London  
DST  
+06:00  
16:00  
The location, time difference and current  
time of the selected city appear.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
6
7
Press the four-way controller (23) to select [DST].  
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
Select O if the destination city uses daylight saving time (DST).  
8
9
Press the 4 button.  
The settings are saved and the screen that was displayed in Step 2  
appears again.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
• Refer to “List of World Time Cities” (p.255) for cities that can be selected as  
a destination.  
9
• Select [W Hometown] in Step 2 to change the city and DST setting.  
X appears in the guide display if [Setting the Time] is set to X (Destination).  
(p.25) Also, the video output setting (p.225) changes to the video output  
format for that city.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
255  
List of World Time Cities  
Video  
Output  
Format  
Video  
Output  
Format  
Region  
City  
Honolulu  
Region  
City  
Istanbul  
North  
America  
NTSC  
Africa/  
West Asia  
PAL  
Anchorage  
Vancouver  
San Francisco  
Los Angeles  
Calgary  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
PAL  
Cairo  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
NTSC  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
NTSC  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
PAL  
NTSC  
Jerusalem  
Nairobi  
Jeddah  
Tehran  
Denver  
Dubai  
Chicago  
Karachi  
Kabul  
Miami  
Toronto  
Male  
New York  
Halifax  
Delhi  
Colombo  
Kathmandu  
Dacca  
Central and Mexico City  
South  
America  
Lima  
Santiago  
Caracas  
Buenos Aires  
Sao Paulo  
Rio de Janeiro  
Lisbon  
East Asia  
Yangon  
Bangkok  
Kuala Lumpur  
Vientiane  
Singapore  
Phnom Penh  
Ho chi Minh  
Jakarta  
PAL  
NTSC  
PAL  
Europe  
Madrid  
PAL  
London  
PAL  
Paris  
PAL  
Hong Kong  
Beijing  
Amsterdam  
Milan  
PAL  
PAL  
Shanghai  
Manila  
9
Rome  
PAL  
Copenhagen  
Berlin  
PAL  
Taipei  
PAL  
Seoul  
Prague  
PAL  
Tokyo  
Stockholm  
Budapest  
Warsaw  
Athens  
PAL  
Guam  
PAL  
Oceania  
Perth  
PAL  
Adelaide  
Sydney  
Noumea  
Wellington  
Auckland  
Pago Pago  
PAL  
Helsinki  
Moscow  
Dakar  
PAL  
PAL  
Africa/  
PAL  
West Asia  
Algiers  
PAL  
Johannesburg  
PAL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
256  
Setting the Display Language  
You can change the language in which the menus, error messages, etc.  
are displayed.  
Set in [Language/u] of the [R Set-up 1] menu.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
257  
Adjusting the Monitor and the Menu  
Display  
Setting the Text Size  
You can set the text size of an item selected on the respective menu  
screens to [Standard] (normal display) or [Large] (magnified display).  
Set in [Text Size] of the [R Set-up 1] menu.  
1
2
3
4
English  
Date Adjustment  
World Time  
Text Size  
Beep  
Guide Display  
Status Screen  
Standard  
Large  
3sec.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Setting the Guide Display Time  
Set the length of time that the guides are displayed on the monitor when  
the camera is turned on or the exposure mode is changed. (p.25)  
Select from [3 sec.] (default setting), [10 sec.], [30 sec.] and [Off].  
Set in [Guide Display] of the [R Set-up 1]  
1
2
3
4
menu.  
English  
Date Adjustment  
World Time  
Text Size  
Beep  
Guide Display  
Status Screen  
3sec.  
10sec.  
30sec.  
Off  
9
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
258  
Setting the Initial Menu Tab Displayed  
Set the initial menu tab displayed on the monitor when the 3 button  
is pressed.  
1
Select [24. Save Menu Location] in the [A Custom  
Setting 4] menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Reset Menu  
Location] or [Save Menu Location] and press the 4  
button.  
The [A Rec. Mode 1] menu ([A Rec. Mode 4] menu  
Reset Menu when the exposure mode is set to C (Movie), and [Q  
1
Location  
Playback 1] menu when in Playback mode) is always  
displayed first. (default setting)  
Save Menu  
Location  
2
The menu tab last selected is displayed first.  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Setting the Status Screen Display  
9
You can set whether to display the status screen on the monitor and set the  
display color of the status screen and control panel.  
1
Select [Status Screen] in the [R Set-up 1] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Status Screen] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
259  
2
3
Use the four-way controller  
(45) to select O or P.  
Status Screen  
Enable  
Auto Screen Rotation  
Displays the status screen. (default  
setting)  
O
Display Color  
1
1/125  
F
5.6  
P
Does not display the status screen.  
MENU  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Auto Screen  
Rotation] and use the four-way controller (45) to select  
O or P.  
If the camera is held vertically while measuring the brightness, the  
O
P
status screen and control panel are displayed vertically. (default  
setting)  
The status screen and control panel are always displayed  
horizontally.  
4
5
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Display Color]  
and use the four-way controller (45) to select from six  
display colors.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
9
Setting the Display for Instant Review  
You can set the Instant Review display settings.  
1
Select [Instant Review] in the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Instant Review] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
260  
2
Press the four-way controller (5)  
and use the four-way controller  
(23) to select a display time.  
Instant Review  
Display Time  
Histogram  
1sec.  
3sec.  
5sec.  
Bright/Dark Area  
Enlarge Instant Review Off  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Histogram],  
[Bright/Dark Area] or [Enlarge Instant Review].  
5
6
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
When [Enlarge Instant Review] is set to O (default setting), you can  
magnify the image with the rear e-dial (S). (p.211)  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Adjusting the Brightness of the Monitor  
You can adjust the brightness of the monitor.  
9
1
Select [Brightness Level] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Brightness Level] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (45)  
to adjust the brightness.  
Brightness Level  
+2  
You can select from 15 brightness levels.  
The value is reset to ±0 when the |  
button is pressed.  
OK  
MENU  
0
Cancel  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
261  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Adjusting the Color of the Monitor  
You can adjust the color of the monitor.  
1
Select [LCD Color Tuning] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [LCD Color Tuning] screen appears.  
2
Adjust the color.  
LCD Color Tuning  
Seven levels are available on the G-M  
and B-A axes.  
G
B
A
M
0
0
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
0
Available operations  
Four-way controller (23) Adjusts the tone of the colors between green (G)  
and magenta (M).  
9
Four-way controller (45) Adjusts the tone of the colors between blue (B)  
and amber (A).  
| button  
Resets the adjustment value.  
Front e-dial (R)  
Displays a saved image in the background so  
you can adjust the color while viewing the  
image. This is useful for matching the color of  
the monitor with that of a computer.  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
262  
Setting the Electronic Level Display  
This camera is equipped with an electronic level for detecting whether the  
camera is level, as indicated on the bar graph in the viewfinder and on the  
LCD panel and monitor. Select whether to display the bar graph.  
1
Select [Electronic Level] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu.  
2
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
O
P
Displays the bar graph of the electronic level.  
Does not display the bar graph of the electronic level. (default setting)  
3
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
The bar graph can be displayed on the monitor when the M button is  
pressed in the control panel. (p.26) When [Electronic Level] is assigned to the  
|/Y button (p.249), press the |/Y button while the status screen or  
Live View is displayed to display the electronic level. (p.149)  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
263  
Setting the Folder/File Number  
Changing the Naming System of the Folder  
You can select a naming system of the folder for storing images.  
Set in [Folder Name] in the [R Set-up 2] menu.  
The two digits of the month and day on which the picture was taken are  
assigned as the folder name in the form of [xxx_MMDD]. [xxx] is a sequential  
Date  
number from 100 to 999. [MMDD] (month and day) appears according to the  
display style set in [Date Adjustment] (p.253). (default setting)  
Example) 101_0125: Folder for images taken on January 25th  
The folder name is assigned in the form of [xxxPENTX].  
Example) 101PENTX  
PENTX  
When the number of storable images exceeds 500, captured images are  
divided into folders of 500 images each. However, in Auto Bracketing shooting,  
images will be stored in the same folder until shooting is completed, even if the  
number of images exceeds 500.  
Creating New Folders  
Creates a new folder on an SD Memory Card. A folder is created with the  
number following the number of the folder currently being used.  
9
1
Select [Create New Folder] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Create New Folder] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2)  
to select [Create folder] and  
Create New Folder  
Creates a new storage folder  
press the 4 button.  
with the following name:  
101 PENTX  
A folder with a new number is created.  
Create folder  
Cancel  
OK  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
264  
Only one folder can be created using this operation. Multiple empty folders  
cannot be created consecutively.  
Setting the File Name  
You can change the file names of images.  
The default naming conventions are as follows depending on the [Color  
Space] (p.189) setting in the [A Rec. Mode 3] menu.  
“xxxx” indicates the file number. This is displayed as a four-digit sequential  
number.  
Color Space  
sRGB  
File Name  
IMGPxxxx.JPG  
_IGPxxxx.JPG  
AdobeRGB  
For sRGB, you can change [IMGP] (4 characters) to the desired  
characters.  
For AdobeRGB, of the 4 characters you selected, the first 3 are assigned  
in place of [IGP].  
Example: When set to [ABCDxxxx.JPG], files are named  
[_ABCxxxx.JPG] for AdobeRGB.  
1
Select [File Name] in the [R Set-up 3] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The [File Name] screen appears.  
9
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Change] and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
File Name  
I
M G P xxxx.jpg  
G P xxxx.jpg  
s
RGB  
_
I
AdobeRGB  
The text-entry screen appears.  
Change  
Select [Reset File Name] to reset a  
Reset File Name  
changed file name to its default setting.  
MENU  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
265  
3
Change the text.  
File Name  
Text selection  
cursor  
Finish  
Text input cursor  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Enter  
Available operations  
Four-way controller  
(2345)  
Moves the text selection cursor.  
Moves the text input cursor.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
4 button  
Enters a character selected with the text selection  
cursor at the position of the text input cursor.  
4
5
After entering the text, move the text selection cursor to  
[Finish] and press the 4 button.  
The file name is changed.  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Selecting the File Number Setting  
You can select a method for assigning the file number of an image when  
saved to a new folder. Set in [File No.] of [Memory] (p.274) in the [A Rec.  
Mode 4] menu.  
9
The file number of the last image saved to the previous folder is saved and  
O
P
subsequent images are assigned sequential file numbers even if a new  
folder is created.  
The file number of the first image saved to a folder returns to 0001 each  
time a new folder is created for saving images.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
266  
Selecting the Power Settings  
Setting the Auto Power Off Function  
You can set the camera to turn off automatically if unused after a certain  
length of time. Select from [1min.] (default setting), [3min.], [5min.],  
[10min.], [30min.] or [Off].  
Set in [Auto Power Off] of the [R Set-up 3]  
1
2
3
4
menu.  
File Name  
IMGP  
Copyright Information 1min.  
Auto Power Off  
Select Battery  
Reset  
3min.  
5min.  
10min.  
30min.  
Off  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
• The Auto Power Off function does not work in the following situations.  
- when the Live View image is displayed  
- when the slideshow is played back  
- when the camera is connected to a computer with a USB cable  
• If the camera turns off after the set length of time, perform one of the following  
operations to reactivate it.  
- Turn on the camera again.  
- Press the shutter release button halfway.  
- Press the Q button, 3 button or M button.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
267  
Selecting a Battery  
You can set the battery priority to the camera or the battery grip when the  
optional battery grip D-BG4 is attached.  
1
Select [Select Battery] in the [R Set-up 3] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Select Battery] screen appears.  
2
3
Press the four-way controller (5).  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select a battery to be  
prioritized and press the 4  
Select Battery  
Auto Select  
Body First  
Grip First  
button.  
Priority is given to the battery  
Auto Select with more power remaining.  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
(default setting)  
Body First/ Priority is given to the  
Grip First  
selected battery.  
4
5
When using AA batteries in the battery grip, use the four-  
way controller (23) to select [AA Battery Type] and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
9
Use the four-way controller (23)  
Select Battery  
to select the AA battery type and  
press the 4 button.  
AUTO  
AA Battery Type  
AUTO  
Auto-detect  
Ni-MH  
AL  
Nickel-Metal Hydride  
Alkaline  
When set to [Auto-detect], the camera will  
automatically detect the type of batteries  
being used.  
Li  
Lithium  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
6
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
268  
• If a battery is inserted into both the body and grip, the battery levels of both  
are checked when the power is turned on. Regardless of the [Select Battery]  
setting, both batteries are slightly used.  
• When the currently selected battery runs out as a result of the check, the  
message [Battery depleted] appears on the monitor. Turn the camera off and  
on again, and the camera will switch to the remaining battery.  
• You can check the battery usage condition on the status screen and LCD  
panel. (p.51)  
When the type of AA batteries inserted in the battery grip differs from the  
battery type setting in Step 5, the battery level will not be correctly determined.  
Please set the correct battery type. Usually, there is no problem using [Auto-  
detect]. However in low temperatures and when using batteries that were  
stored for long periods of time, set the appropriate battery type so the camera  
can correctly determine the remaining battery level.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
269  
Setting the Photographer Information  
The camera type, shooting conditions and other information are  
automatically embedded in captured images in the Exif data format. You  
can embed photographer information in this Exif.  
Use the provided software (p.283) to check the Exif information.  
1
Select [Copyright Information] in the [R Set-up 3] menu  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Copyright Information] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller  
(45) to select O or P.  
Copyright Information  
Embed Copyright Data  
Photographer  
Embeds copyright information in the  
Exif.  
O
Copyright Holder  
Does not embed copyright  
P
information in the Exif. (default  
setting)  
MENU  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Photographer]  
and press the four-way controller (5).  
The text-entry screen appears.  
9
Enter the text.  
Photographer  
Text selection  
Up to 32 single-byte  
cursor  
alphanumeric  
characters and  
Finish  
Text input cursor  
symbols can be  
entered.  
Delete One Character  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
Enter  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
270  
Available operations  
Four-way controller  
(2345)  
Moves the text selection cursor.  
Moves the text input cursor.  
Rear e-dial (S)  
| button  
Switches between upper and lower case  
letters.  
4 button  
Enters a character selected with the text  
selection cursor at the position of the text input  
cursor.  
i button  
Deletes a character at the position of the text  
input cursor.  
5
6
7
After entering the text, move the text selection cursor to  
[Finish] and press the 4 button.  
The camera returns to the [Copyright Information] screen.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Copyright  
Holder] and enter the text in the same way as  
[Photographer].  
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
271  
Setting the DPOF Settings  
By adding DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) settings to stored images on  
the SD Memory Card, you can specify the number of copies and whether  
to imprint the date on the images in advance and order conventional  
photograph prints by taking this SD Memory Card to a store for printing.  
• DPOF settings cannot be applied to RAW images and movies.  
• You can make DPOF settings for up to 999 images.  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Playback mode.  
The playback mode palette appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select r (DPOF)  
and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select how to change the settings is displayed.  
3
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Single Image] or [All  
Images] and press the 4  
Single Image  
button.  
All Images  
If you selected [All Images], proceed to  
Step 5.  
OK  
MENU  
Use the four-way controller (45) to select an Image.  
Use the four-way controller (23)  
OK  
4
5
9
100-0105  
to select the number of copies.  
You can set up to 99 copies.  
K appears at the top right of the screen  
for images with DPOF settings.  
To cancel the DPOF settings, set the  
number of copies to [00].  
Copies  
01  
Date  
OK  
MENU  
Date  
OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
272  
6
7
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to select O or P for printing the  
date.  
O
P
The date will be printed.  
The date will not be printed.  
Repeat Steps 4 to 6 to make DPOF settings for other images.  
Press the 4 button.  
The DPOF settings for the selected image is saved and the camera  
returns to Playback mode.  
• Depending on the printer or printing equipment at the photo processing lab,  
the date may not be printed on the pictures.  
• The number of copies specified for all images is applied to all the images, and  
that specified for a single image is canceled.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
273  
Correcting Defective Pixels in the  
CMOS Sensor (Pixel Mapping)  
Pixel Mapping is a function for mapping out and correcting defective pixels  
in the CMOS sensor.  
1
Select [Pixel Mapping] in the [R Set-up 4] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Pixel Mapping] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Pixel Mapping]  
and press the 4 button.  
Defective pixels are mapped out and corrected, and the screen that was  
displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
When the battery level is low, the message [Not enough battery power  
remaining to activate Pixel Mapping] is displayed on the monitor. Use the AC  
adapter kit (optional) or change to the battery with ample power remaining.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
274  
Selecting Settings to Save in the  
Camera (Memory)  
You can select which function settings to save when the camera is turned  
off. The following function settings can be saved.  
Default  
Setting  
Default  
Setting  
Function  
Flash Mode  
Function  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Cross Processing  
Extended Bracketing  
Digital Filter  
P
O
P
Drive Mode  
White Balance  
Custom Image  
Sensitivity  
HDR Capture  
P
Playback Info Display  
File No.  
O
O
EV Compensation  
Flash Exposure Comp.  
[Memory] cannot be selected when the mode dial is set to A.  
1
Select [Memory] in the [A Rec. Mode 5] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Memory 1] screen appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to choose an item.  
1
2
Memory  
Flash Mode  
Drive Mode  
White Balance  
Custom Image  
Sensitivity  
9
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to display the  
[Memory 2] screen.  
EV Compensation  
Flash Exposure Comp.  
MENU  
3
Use the four-way controller (45) to select O or P.  
Settings are saved even when the camera is turned  
off.  
O
Settings are cleared and returned to their default  
values when the camera is turned off.  
P
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
275  
4
Press the 3 button twice.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
• Set [File No.] to O (On) to continue the sequential numbering for the file  
name even if a new folder is created. Refer to “Selecting the File Number  
• When the [R Set-up] menu is reset (p.296), all Memory settings return to the  
default values.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
276  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10 Connecting to a  
Computer  
This chapter explains how to connect the camera to your  
computer, install the supplied CD-ROM, etc.  
Computer ............................................................278  
Using the Provided Software ............................281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
278  
Manipulating Captured Images on a  
Computer  
The captured still pictures and movies can be transferred to a computer by  
connecting this camera using a USB cable and can be managed using the  
provided software.  
We recommend the following system requirements to connect your  
camera to a computer or to use the software “PENTAX Digital Camera  
Utility 4” included on the CD-ROM (S-SW132).  
 Windows  
Windows XP (SP3 or later), Windows Vista, or Windows 7 (can  
be run as a 32-bit application on any x64 Edition of Windows.)  
OS  
Pentium D 3.0 GHz equivalent or higher (Intel Core 2 Duo  
processor 2.0 GHz equivalent or higher recommended)  
CPU  
RAM  
2.0 GB or more (3.0 GB or more recommended)  
Free Disk Space 1 GB or more (8 GB or more recommended)  
1280×800 pixels or more (1920×1200 or more recommended)  
with 24-bit full color (approximately 16.77 million colors)  
Monitor  
Others  
USB 2.0 port must be standard equipment  
 Macintosh  
OS  
Mac OS X 10.4.11, 10.5, 10.6, or 10.7  
PowerPC G5 Dual-core 2.0 GHz or higher (Intel Core 2 Duo  
processor 2.0 GHz or higher recommended. Universal Binary  
format.)  
CPU  
RAM  
2.0 GB minimum (4.0 GB or more recommended)  
Free Disk Space 1 GB minimum (8 GB or more recommended)  
10  
1280×800 pixels or more (1920×1200 or more recommended)  
Monitor  
Others  
with 24-bit full color (approximately 16.77 million colors)  
USB 2.0 port must be standard equipment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
279  
Saving Images on Your Computer  
Setting the USB Connection Mode  
Set the USB connection mode when connecting the camera to a  
computer.  
1
Select [USB Connection] in the [R Set-up 2] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
2
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [MSC] or [PTP].  
Mass Storage Class (default setting)  
MSC A general-purpose driver program that handles devices connected  
to a computer via USB as a memory device.  
Picture Transfer Protocol  
PTP A protocol that allows transfer of digital images and control of digital  
cameras via USB.  
Unless otherwise specified, select [MSC].  
3
4
Press the 4 button.  
Press the 3 button.  
The screen that was displayed before selecting the menu appears again.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
280  
Connecting the Camera and a Computer  
Connect the camera to a computer using the provided USB cable I-USB7.  
1
Turn your computer on.  
2
Turn the camera off, and use the USB cable to connect the  
PC/AV terminal of the camera and the computer.  
3
Turn your camera on.  
The camera is recognized as a removable disk or an SD Memory Card  
with a volume label “K-5 II”.  
If the “K-5 II” dialog appears when the camera is turned on, select [Open  
folder to view files using Windows Explorer] and click the OK button.  
4
5
Save the captured images to your computer.  
10  
Copy the image file(s) or folder(s) to the hard disk of the computer.  
Disconnect your camera from your computer.  
The camera cannot be operated while it is connected to the computer. To  
operate the camera, terminate the USB connection on the computer, then turn  
off the camera and remove the USB cable.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
281  
Using the Provided Software  
“PENTAX Digital Camera Utility 4” is included on the CD-ROM  
(S-SW132). Using the PENTAX Digital Camera Utility 4, you can manage  
images saved on your computer, and develop RAW files taken with this  
camera and adjust the color of the images.  
Compatible file formats:.bmp (BMP)/.jpg (JPEG)/.pef (files recorded in  
PENTAX’s original RAW format)/.png (PNG)/.tif  
(TIFF)/.dng (DNG format RAW file)  
Installing the Software  
You can install the software from the provided CD-ROM.  
When multiple accounts have been setup on your computer, log on with  
an account that has administrative rights before installing the software.  
1
Turn your computer on.  
Make sure no other software is running.  
2
Place the CD-ROM into the CD/DVD drive on the computer.  
The [PENTAX Software Installer] screen appears.  
If the [PENTAX Software Installer] screen does not appear  
• For Windows  
1 Click [My Computer] from the Start menu.  
2 Double-click the [CD/DVD drive (S-SW132)] icon.  
3 Double-click the [Setup.exe] icon.  
10  
• For Macintosh  
1 Double-click the CD/DVD (S-SW132) icon on the desktop.  
2 Double-click the [PENTAX Installer] icon.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
282  
3
Click [PENTAX Digital Camera  
Utility 4].  
For Macintosh, follow the instructions  
on the screen to perform subsequent  
steps.  
4
5
Select the desired language in  
the [Choose Setup Language]  
screen and click [OK].  
When the [InstallShield  
Wizard] screen appears in the  
selected language, click  
[Next].  
Follow the instructions on the screen  
to perform subsequent steps.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
283  
Screens of the PENTAX Digital Camera Utility 4  
When PENTAX Digital Camera Utility 4 is launched, the following screen  
(browser) appears.  
The screenshots used in this explanation are for Windows.  
 Browser tab set (default setting)  
You can perform the file management functions such as viewing and  
organizing the images.  
1
2
3
4
3
10  
5
1Menu Bar  
This executes functions or makes various settings.  
For Macintosh, the Menu bar appears at the top of the desktop.  
2Tool Bar  
Frequently used functions are provided as Tool bar buttons.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
284  
3Control Panel  
Shooting information and settings of the selected image appear in this  
panel. The set of tab pages displayed in Control Panel can be changed  
by pressing the Browser, Laboratory and Custom buttons on the Tool  
bar.  
4File Display Pane  
The file list and the images in the selected folder appear here.  
5Status Bar  
Information on the selected item appears.  
 Laboratory tab set (default setting)  
The control panel for adjusting the image appears here.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
285  
 Custom tab set (default setting)  
The screen display can be customized here.  
The Custom tab pages enable you to customize whether to show/hide  
the various tab pages in accordance with your needs. By default, all tab  
pages are displayed.  
Viewing Detailed Information on the Software  
Refer to Help for details on using the software program.  
10  
1
Click the  
bar.  
button on the Tool  
Or, select [PENTAX Digital Camera  
Utility Help] from the [Help] menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
286  
Regarding Product Registration  
To better serve you, please take a moment to register your software.  
Click [Product Registration] on the  
screen in Step 3 on p.282.  
A world map for Internet Product  
Registration is displayed. If your  
computer is connected to the  
Internet, click the displayed country  
or region and then follow the  
instructions to register your software.  
Note that you can only register online  
if your country or area is shown.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
11 Appendix  
Default Settings ..................................................288  
Resetting the Menus ..........................................296  
Combinations .....................................................297  
Cleaning the CMOS Sensor ...............................300  
Using the GPS Unit ............................................305  
Error Messages ..................................................310  
Troubleshooting .................................................313  
Main Specifications ............................................315  
Index ....................................................................321  
WARRANTY POLICY ..........................................327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
288  
Default Settings  
The table below shows the factory default settings.  
The functions set in Memory (p.274) are saved even when the camera is  
turned off.  
Reset Setting  
Yes: The setting returns to the default setting with the reset function  
(p.296).  
No : The setting is saved even after reset.  
Direct Keys  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
9 (Single Frame  
Drive Mode  
Flash Mode  
Yes  
Shooting)  
Depends on the  
capture mode  
Yes  
White Balance  
Custom Image  
F (Auto)  
Yes  
Yes  
Bright  
[A Rec. Mode] Menu  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
USER Mode  
A1  
Yes  
e (Program  
Automatic Exposure)  
Exposure Mode  
Yes  
File Format  
JPEG  
p (4928×3264)  
C(Best)  
11 AF Points  
P (Off)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
JPEG Recorded Pixels  
JPEG Quality  
11  
AUTO AF Point Setting  
Expanded Area AF  
AF Settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
289  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Distortion Correction  
Lat-Chromatic-Ab Adj  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Lens  
Correction  
Cross Processing  
Type  
BA±1 (White  
Balance)/  
±1 (other than White  
Balance)  
Extended  
Bracketing  
Bracketing Amount  
Yes  
Digital Filter  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Not use any filters  
Off  
HDR Capture  
HDR  
Capture  
Auto Align  
P (Off)  
Number of Shots  
Auto EV Adjustment  
Interval  
2 times  
Multi-  
exposure  
P (Off)  
00:00'01"  
2 images  
Now  
Number of Shots  
Start Interval  
Interval  
Shooting  
Start Time  
12:00AM / 00:00  
Center  
X-Y direction  
Composition  
Adjust.  
Rotation  
±0°  
Recall Previous Position  
Highlight Correction  
Shadow Correction  
Sensitivity limit  
AUTO ISO Parameters  
P (Off)  
Off  
D-Range  
Setting  
Off  
100 – 3200  
s (Standard)  
Auto  
ISO AUTO  
Setting  
High-ISO NR  
Slow Shutter Speed NR  
Program Line  
Auto  
k (Normal)  
11  
Color Space  
sRGB  
PEF  
RAW File Format  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
290  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
b (1280×720,  
16:9, 30 fps)  
Recorded Pixels  
Yes  
Quality Level  
Sound  
C(Best)  
g (On)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Movie  
Cross Processing  
Digital Filter  
Off  
Not use any filters  
Fixed  
Movie Aperture Control  
Shake Reduction  
Autofocus Method  
Show Grid  
l (Off)  
I
(Face Detection AF)  
Off  
Live  
View  
Info Overlay  
O (On)  
Histogram  
P (Off)  
Bright/Dark Area  
P (Off)  
Electronic Level  
P (Off)  
Horizon Correction  
P (Off)  
k (On)  
Shake Reduction  
Input Focal Length  
35 mm  
Electronic Compass  
Simple Navigation  
Timed  
P (Off)  
5'00"  
Yes  
Yes  
Exposure  
ASTRO-  
TRACER  
(Bulb)  
Exposure  
Time Preset  
GPS  
Precise  
Calibration  
Calibration  
Positioning Interval  
Auto Time Synch.  
Display Time  
1min.  
On  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
11  
1 sec.  
P (Off)  
P (Off)  
O (On)  
Histogram  
Instant  
Review  
Bright/Dark Area  
Enlarge Instant Review  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
291  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Histogram  
P (Off)  
P (Off)  
O (On)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Digital  
Preview  
Bright/Dark Area  
Enlarge Instant Review  
Rb, Sc,  
e
|}e  
K
b
R
–, So  
,
|–  
Rb, S–, |–  
c
R
–, Sc  
,
|
E-Dial  
Programming  
Yes  
Rb, Sc,  
L/a  
|eLINE  
p
R
–, Sc  
R–, Sc, |  
–, Sc  
|cSHIFT  
,
|
M
R
,
C
One Push File  
Format  
|/Y Button  
= Button  
Enable AF  
Button  
Customization  
Yes  
Preview Dial  
Optical Preview  
Shutter Button Half  
Press  
Enable AF  
Cross Processing,  
Digital Filter, HDR  
Capture  
P (Off)  
Yes  
Yes  
Memory  
Other than the above  
functions  
O (On)  
Yes  
Save USER Mode  
*1 Appears only when the mode dial is set to A.  
*2 The saved settings are reset only with [Reset USER Mode] in the [Save USER Mode]  
screen.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
292  
Playback Mode Palette  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Image Rotation  
Digital Filter  
Toy Camera  
Yes  
Maximum size  
according to the setting  
Resize  
Maximum size  
according to the setting  
Cropping  
Protect  
No  
Slideshow  
Save as Manual WB  
File Format: JPEG  
Recorded Pixels: p  
Quality Level: C  
RAW Development  
Yes  
Index  
Movie Editing  
DPOF  
No  
Save Destination  
[Q Playback] Menu  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Interval  
3 sec.  
Off  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Slideshow  
Screen Effect  
Repeat Playback  
P (Off)  
Off  
Quick Zoom  
Bright/Dark Area  
Auto Image Rotation  
Delete All Images  
P (Off)  
O (On)  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
293  
[R Set-up] Menu  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Language/u  
Date Adjustment  
English  
01/01/2012  
Setting the Time  
W (Hometown)  
Same as Hometown  
Same as Hometown  
According to initial setting  
According to initial setting  
According to initial setting  
3
Destination (City)  
World Time Destination (DST)  
Hometown (City)  
Hometown (DST)  
Text Size  
Volume  
Beep  
Yes  
Setting  
All O (On)  
Guide Display  
Status Screen  
3 sec.  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
O (On)  
Status  
Screen  
Auto Screen Rotation  
O (On)  
Display Color  
Brightness Level  
LCD Color Tuning  
Video Out  
1
±0  
±0  
According to initial setting  
Auto  
HDMI Out  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
USB Connection  
Folder Name  
MSC  
Date  
Create New Folder  
File Name  
No  
IMGP/_IGP  
Embed Copyright  
Data  
P (Off)  
Copyright  
Information Photographer  
Copyright Holder  
No  
11  
Auto Power Off  
1 min.  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Select Battery  
Select  
Auto Select  
Battery  
AA Battery Type  
Auto-detect  
Reset  
Pixel Mapping  
Dust Alert  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
294  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Dust Removal  
Start-up Action  
Yes  
Dust  
Removal  
O (On)  
Sensor Cleaning  
Format  
*3 The setting can be reset only with [Reset File Name] in the [File Name] screen.  
[A Custom Setting] Menu  
Reset  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
Setting  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
1. EV Steps  
1/3 EV Steps  
1 EV Step  
Off  
2. Sensitivity Steps  
3. Expanded Sensitivity  
4. Meter Operating Time  
5. AE-L with AF Locked  
6. Link AE to AF Point  
7. Auto EV Compensation  
8. Auto Bracketing Order  
9. One-Push Bracketing  
10. WB Adjustable Range  
11. WB When Using Flash  
12. AWB in Tungsten Light  
13. Color Temperature Steps  
14. Superimpose AF Area  
15. AF.S Setting  
10 sec.  
Off  
Off  
Off  
0 - +  
Off  
Auto Adjustment  
Auto White Balance  
Subtle Correction  
Kelvin  
On  
Focus-priority  
Focus-priority  
On  
16. AF.C Setting  
17. AF Assist Light  
18. AF with Remote Control  
19. Remote Control in Bulb  
20. Release While Charging  
21. Flash in Wireless Mode  
22. LCD Panel Illumination  
23. Saving Rotation Info  
24. Save Menu Location  
Off  
11  
Mode1  
Off  
On  
High  
On  
Reset Menu Location  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
295  
Reset  
Setting  
Item  
Default Setting  
Page  
25. Catch-in Focus  
Off  
Yes  
26. AF Fine Adjustment  
27. Using Aperture Ring  
Reset Custom Functions  
Off  
Prohibited  
Yes  
Yes  
*4 The saved adjustment value is reset only with [Reset] in the [26. AF Fine Adjustment]  
screen.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
296  
Resetting the Menus  
Resetting the Rec. Mode/Playback/Set-up Menus  
Settings in the [  
A
Rec. Mode] menu, [  
Q
Playback] menu, [  
R
Set-up]  
menu, direct keys and playback mode palette can be reset to default settings.  
Language/u, Date Adjustment, the city and DST settings for World Time,  
Text Size, Video Output, Copyright Information and [A Custom Setting] menu  
settings are not reset.  
[Reset] cannot be selected when the mode dial is set to A.  
1
Select [Reset] in the [R Set-up 3] menu and press the four-  
way controller (5).  
The [Reset] screen appears.  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Reset] and  
press the 4 button.  
The settings are reset, and the screen that was displayed before  
selecting the menu appears again.  
Resetting the Custom Menu  
Reset settings in [A Custom Setting] menu to default values.  
1
Select [Reset Custom Functions] in the [A Custom  
Setting 4] menu and press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Reset Custom Functions] screen appears.  
11  
2
Press the four-way controller (2) to select [Reset] and  
press the 4 button.  
The settings are reset, and the screen that was displayed before  
selecting the menu appears again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
297  
Functions Available with Various  
Lens Combinations  
All camera capture modes are available when DA, DA L, or FA J lens is  
used, or when a lens with an  
set to the position.  
s
(Auto) position is used with the aperture ring  
s
When they are used in a position other than  
the following restrictions apply.  
s, or other lenses are used,  
z: Functions are available when the aperture ring is set to the  
# : Some functions are restricted.  
s
position.  
× : Functions are unavailable.  
DA  
DA L  
D FA  
FA J  
A
M
P
Lens  
[Mount type]  
[KAF]  
[KAF]  
[KAF]  
[KA]  
[K]  
[KAF2]  
[KAF3]  
[KAF2]  
Function  
Autofocus  
(Lens only)  
(With AF adapter 1.7×)  
z
z
z
#
#
Manual focus  
(With the focus indicator)  
(With matte field)  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
Quick-Shift Focus System  
#
×
×
×
×
×
×
Eleven AF points/Five AF points  
Multi-segment metering  
e/K/b/c/L mode  
a mode  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
#
z
z
z
z
#
#
×
P-TTL Auto Flash  
Power Zoom  
Automatically obtaining the lens focal  
length information when using the  
Shake Reduction function  
11  
z
z
z
×
×
×
Lens Correction function  
z
×
×
×
*1 Lenses with a maximum aperture of F2.8 or faster. Only available at the s position.  
*2 Lenses with a maximum aperture of F5.6 or faster.  
*3 When using the built-in flash, AF540FGZ, AF360FGZ, AF200FG and/or AF160FC.  
*4 Only available with compatible lenses.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
298  
*5 The [Distortion Correction] setting is disabled when using the DA 10-17mm FISH-EYE  
lens.  
*6 To use an FA SOFT 28mm F2.8 lens, FA SOFT 85mm F2.8 lens, or F SOFT 85mm F2.8  
lens, set [27. Using Aperture Ring] to [Permitted] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu.  
Pictures can be taken with the aperture you set, but only within manual aperture range.  
*7 Only available with KAF2 mount FA lenses.  
*8 Only available with an FA 31mm F1.8 Limited, FA 43mm F1.9 Limited, or FA 77mm F1.8  
Limited lens.  
*9 The focusing area is fixed to U (Center).  
*10 c (Aperture Priority Automatic Exposure) mode with the aperture set wide open.  
(Adjusting the aperture ring has no effect on the actual aperture value.)  
Lens Names and Mount Names  
DA lenses with a motor and FA zoom lenses with a power zoom function  
use the KAF2 mount. DA lenses with a motor and no AF coupler use the  
KAF3 mount.  
FA single focal length lenses (non-zoom lenses), DA or DA L lenses  
without a motor and D FA, FA J and F lenses use the KAF mount.  
Refer to respective lens manuals for details.  
Lenses and Accessories that Cannot be Used with this Camera  
When the aperture ring is set to other than the s (Auto) position or a lens  
without an s position or accessories such as an auto extension tube or  
auto bellows are used, the camera will not operate unless [27. Using  
Aperture Ring] is set to [Permitted] in the [A Custom Setting 4] menu.  
Refer to “Using the Aperture Ring” (p.299) for restrictions that apply.  
Lens and Built-in Flash  
The built-in flash cannot be regulated and fully discharges when the  
aperture ring is set to other than the s (Auto) position, pre A lenses or soft  
focus lenses are used.  
Note that the built-in flash cannot be used as an Auto Flash.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
299  
Using the Aperture Ring  
The shutter can be released even if the  
aperture ring of the D FA, FA, F or A lens is  
not set to the s position or a lens without an  
s position is attached.  
27. Using Aperture Ring  
1
2
Prohibited  
Permitted  
Select [Permitted] in [27. Using Aperture  
Ring] of the [A Custom Setting 4] menu.  
The following restrictions apply depending  
on the lens being used.  
Shutter will release when  
aperture ring is not set to the  
"A" position  
OK  
MENU  
Cancel  
OK  
Exposure  
Lens Used  
Mode  
Restriction  
The aperture remains open regardless  
of the aperture ring position. The shutter  
speed changes in relation to the open  
aperture but an exposure deviation may  
occur. [F--] appears for the aperture  
indicator.  
D FA, FA, F, A, M (lens  
only or with auto  
diaphragm accessories  
such as auto extension  
tube K)  
c
D FA, FA, F, A, M, S (with  
diaphragm accessories  
such as extension tube K)  
Pictures can be taken with a set  
aperture value but an exposure  
deviation may occur. [F--] appears for  
the aperture indicator.  
c
c
Manualdiaphragmlens such  
as reflex lens (lens only)  
Pictures can be taken with a set  
aperture value in the manual aperture  
range. [F--] appears for the aperture  
indicator.  
The exposure can be checked with  
Optical Preview.  
FA SOFT 28mm,  
FA SOFT 85mm,  
F SOFT 85mm  
(lens only)  
c
a
Pictures can be taken with a set  
aperture value and shutter speed. [F--]  
appears for the aperture indicator.  
The exposure can be checked with  
Optical Preview.  
All lenses  
11  
The camera operates in c (Aperture Priority Automatic Exposure) mode even  
if the mode dial is at B, e, K, b or L when the aperture ring is set to  
other than the s position.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
300  
Cleaning the CMOS Sensor  
If the CMOS sensor becomes dirty or dusty, shadows may appear in the  
image in certain situations such as when shooting against a white  
background. This indicates that the CMOS sensor must be cleaned.  
Removing Dust with Ultrasonic Vibrations  
(Dust Removal)  
Dust adhering to the CMOS sensor is removed by applying ultrasonic  
vibrations to the filter on the front surface of the CMOS sensor.  
1
Select [Dust Removal] in the [R Set-up 4] menu and press  
the four-way controller (5).  
The [Dust Removal] screen appears.  
2
Press the 4 button.  
Dust Removal  
Dust Removal  
Start-up Action  
The Dust Removal function is activated.  
Set [Start-up Action] to O (On) to turn the  
Dust Removal function on every time the  
camera is turned on.  
When Dust Removal is completed, the  
camera returns to the [R Set-up 4] menu.  
OK  
MENU  
Start  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
301  
Detecting Dust on the CMOS Sensor  
(Dust Alert)  
Dust Alert is a function that detects dust adhering to the CMOS sensor and  
visually displays the location of the dust.  
You can save an image indicating the dust location and display it when  
performing sensor cleaning (p.303).  
The following conditions must be met before using the Dust Alert function:  
- A DA, DA L, FA J lens or a D FA, FA or F lens that has an s (Auto)  
position is attached.  
- The aperture is set to the s position when using a lens with an  
aperture ring.  
- The mode dial is set to any mode other than C (Movie).  
- The focus mode switch is set to l or A.  
• The exposure time may be extremely long when using the Dust Alert  
function. Note that if the direction of the lens is changed before processing is  
complete, dust will not be detected properly.  
• Depending on the subject conditions or temperature, dust may not be  
detected properly.  
• The Dust Alert image can only be displayed during sensor cleaning within 30  
minutes from the time the image is saved. If more than 30 minutes elapse,  
save a new Dust Alert image and then perform sensor cleaning.  
• The saved Dust Alert image cannot be displayed in Playback mode.  
• The Dust Alert image is saved only when an SD Memory Card is inserted.  
1
Select [Dust Alert] in the [R Set-up 4] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The [Dust Alert] screen appears.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
302  
2
3
Fully display a white wall or other  
bright subject with no detail in  
the viewfinder and press the  
shutter release button fully.  
Dust Alert  
Checks for dust on the sensor.  
Press shutter release button  
to reveal dust location  
After image processing is performed, the  
Dust Alert image appears.  
MENU  
SHUTTER  
Check  
If the message [The operation could not  
be completed correctly] is displayed,  
press the 4 button and take another picture.  
Check the sensor for dust.  
OK  
x1  
Exit  
Available operations  
Rear e-dial (S)  
Displays the Dust Alert image at full screen  
display.  
4
Press the 4 button.  
The Dust Alert image is saved and the camera returns to the [R Set-up  
4] menu.  
Regardless of the camera settings, the Dust Alert image will be taken with  
specific shooting conditions.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
303  
Removing Dust with a Blower  
Raise the mirror up and open the shutter when cleaning the CMOS sensor  
with a blower.  
Please contact a PENTAX Service Center for professional cleaning  
because the CMOS sensor is a precision part. Cleaning services involve  
a fee.  
You can use the optional Imagesensor Cleaning kit O-ICK1 when cleaning  
the CMOS sensor.  
• Do not use a spray type blower.  
• Do not perform Sensor Cleaning during Bulb shooting. The shutter may  
accidentally close and may cause damage to the camera’s internal parts.  
• To prevent dirt and dust from accumulating on the CMOS sensor, keep the  
lens mount cap on the camera when a lens is not attached.  
• When the battery level is low, the message [Not enough battery power  
remaining to clean sensor] is displayed on the monitor.  
• It is recommended to use the AC adapter kit (optional) when cleaning the  
sensor. If you are not using the AC adapter kit, please install the battery with  
ample capacity remaining. If the battery capacity becomes low during  
cleaning, a warning beep will sound. In this case, stop cleaning immediately.  
• Do not put the tip of the blower inside the lens mount area. If the power is  
turned off, this may cause damage to the shutter, CMOS sensor and the  
mirror.  
• The self-timer lamp blinks, and [d] and [Cln] appear on the LCD panel  
while cleaning the sensor.  
• This camera may generate a vibration sound while cleaning the CMOS  
sensor. It is not a malfunction.  
1
Turn the camera off and remove the lens.  
Turn the camera on.  
2
3
11  
Select [Sensor Cleaning] in the [R Set-up 4] menu and  
press the four-way controller (5).  
The [Sensor Cleaning] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
304  
4
5
Press the four-way controller (2)  
to select [Mirror Up] and press  
the 4 button.  
Sensor Cleaning  
Raises mirror and opens shutter  
for access to clean sensor.  
Turn the power off to finish  
The mirror is locked in the up position.  
Mirror Up  
Cancel  
If you used Dust Alert to detect dust on  
the sensor within the last 30 minutes, the  
Dust Alert image appears on the monitor.  
Clean the sensor while checking the  
location of the dust.  
OK  
OK  
Clean the CMOS sensor.  
Use a brush-less blower to remove dirt  
and dust from the CMOS sensor. Using a  
blower with a brush may scratch the  
CMOS sensor. Do not wipe the CMOS  
sensor with a cloth.  
6
7
Turn off the camera.  
The mirror automatically returns to its original position.  
Attach the lens or body mount cover.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
305  
Using the GPS Unit  
The following functions are available when the optional GPS unit O-GPS1  
is attached to this camera.  
Displays the latitude,  
N
36°45.410'  
longitude, altitudeof the  
current location, lens  
direction and  
Coordinated Universal  
Time (UTC).  
W140°02.000'  
89m  
0°  
Electronic Compass  
10/10/2012  
NewYork  
10:00:00  
Displays the direction  
and distance from the  
current location, based  
on the latitude and  
longitude of the set  
destination. You can  
save the GPS location  
information stored in a  
captured image as the  
destination or load the  
destination from a  
Current Location  
36°45.410'  
N
0°  
W140°02.000'  
89m  
Direction of Destination  
Distance to Destination  
10/10/2012  
270°  
10000km  
10:00:00  
Simple Navigation  
location information file  
created on a computer.  
(p.306)  
Tracks and captures celestial bodies. By matching the  
movement of the camera’s built-in shake reduction unit  
with the movement of celestial bodies, celestial bodies  
can be captured as individual points even when shooting  
with a long exposure setting. (p.308)  
ASTROTRACER  
Auto Time Synch.  
Automatically adjusts the camera’s date and time  
settings using information acquired from GPS satellites.  
11  
• Refer to the manual of the GPS unit for details on how to attach the unit and  
information on the unit’s functions.  
• If [GPS] is assigned to the V/Y button, you can display the Electronic  
Compass, Simple Navigation, or ASTROTRACER screen by pressing the  
V/Y button. (p.249)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
306  
Displaying the Distance and Direction to the  
Destination (Simple Navigation)  
Saving the Destination  
You can save the GPS location information stored in an image as the  
destination for Simple Navigation. Up to 38 destinations can be saved.  
1
Press the four-way controller (3) in Playback mode.  
The playback mode palette appears.  
2
Use the four-way controller (2345) to select U (Save  
Destination) and press the 4 button.  
The screen to select an image appears and the GPS location information  
stored in the image is displayed.  
If there are no images that have GPS location information stored, [No  
image can be processed] appears.  
3
4
Use the four-way controller (45)  
100-0001  
to select the image with the GPS  
location information you want to  
set as a destination, and press  
the 4 button.  
N
36°45.410'  
W140°02.000'  
The [Destination Name] screen appears.  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
Enter the name of the destination to save.  
Enter the name in the same way as [Copyright Information]. Refer to Step  
11  
Up to 18 single-byte characters can be entered.  
When the name is set, the screen to save the destination data in the  
destination list appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
307  
5
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select the desired position in  
the destination list to save.  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Madrid  
London  
Paris  
5/38  
Amsterdom  
Milan  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to switch  
between pages.  
Select desired position  
in destination list  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
6
7
Press the 4 button.  
The save confirmation screen appears.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Save] and  
press the 4 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 3 appears again.  
Repeat Steps 3 to 7 to save other images.  
8
Press the 3 button twice.  
Destination list data can be stored on an SD Memory Card. The stored  
destination list files can also be edited on a computer. Refer to the manual of  
the GPS unit for details.  
Starting the Navigation  
1
Select [GPS] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
The [GPS] screen appears.  
11  
2
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Simple Navigation] and  
press the four-way controller  
GPS  
Electronic Compass  
Simple Navigation  
ASTROTRACER (Bulb)  
(5).  
Calibration  
Positioning Interval  
Auto Time Synch.  
1min.  
The [Simple Navigation] screen appears.  
MENU  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
308  
3
Use the four-way controller (23)  
to select [Select Destination] and  
press the four-way controller  
(5).  
Simple Navigation  
Navigation Start  
Select Destination  
NewYork  
The destination selection screen  
appears.  
Destination Manager  
MENU  
4
5
6
Use the four-way controller (23) to select a destination.  
Turn the rear e-dial (S) to switch between pages.  
Press the 4 button.  
The screen that was displayed in Step 3 appears again.  
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Navigation  
Start] and press the 4 button.  
The current latitude, longitude, altitude, direction of the destination,  
distance to the destination, and Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) are  
displayed.  
Press the shutter release button halfway to switch the camera to Capture  
mode.  
Shooting Celestial Bodies (ASTROTRACER)  
1
Set the mode dial to p.  
2
Select [GPS] in the [A Rec. Mode 4] menu and press the  
four-way controller (5).  
11  
The [GPS] screen appears.  
3
Select [ASTROTRACER (Bulb)] and press the four-way  
controller (5).  
The [ASTROTRACER (Bulb)] screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
309  
4
To set the desired exposure time,  
first set [Timed Exposure] to O  
(On).  
ASTROTRACER (Bulb)  
Max. Trace Duration  
5' 00"  
Start Shooting  
Timed Exposure  
Exposure Time Preset  
You can set the exposure time between  
0'01" and 5'00" in [Exposure Time  
Preset].  
5' 00"  
Precise Calibration  
OK  
MENU Cancel  
OK  
5
6
7
Use the four-way controller (23) to select [Start  
Shooting] and press the 4 button.  
Press the shutter release button fully.  
Shooting starts.  
Press the shutter release button fully again.  
Exposure ends.  
When [Timed Exposure] is enabled, shooting ends automatically after  
the set time has elapsed.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
310  
Error Messages  
Error message  
Description  
The SD Memory Card is full and no more  
images can be saved. Insert a new SD Memory  
Card or delete unwanted images. (p.54, p.74)  
Data may be saved when you perform the  
following operations.  
Memory card full  
• Change the file format to JPEG. (p.180)  
• Change the JPEG Recorded Pixels or JPEG  
Quality setting. (p.178, p.179)  
There are no images that can be played back  
on the SD Memory Card.  
No image  
You are trying to play back an image in a format  
not supported by this camera. You may be able  
to play it back on another brand of camera or  
your computer.  
This image cannot be displayed  
The SD Memory Card is not inserted in the  
No card in the camera  
Cannot use this card  
The inserted SD Memory Card is not  
compatible with this camera.  
The SD Memory Card has a problem, and  
image capture and playback are impossible. It  
may be viewable on a computer but not with this  
camera.  
Memory card error  
The SD Memory Card you have inserted is  
unformatted or has been formatted on another  
device and is not compatible with this camera.  
Use the card after formatting it with this camera.  
(p.246)  
Card is not formatted  
Card is locked  
The write-protect switch on an SD Memory  
Card you have inserted is locked. Unlock the  
SD Memory Card. (p.6)  
11  
The card is  
electronically locked  
Data is protected by an SD Memory Card  
security feature.  
This image cannot be  
enlarged  
You are trying to enlarge an image that cannot  
be enlarged.  
You are trying to delete an image that is  
protected. Remove protection from the image.  
(p.222)  
This image is protected  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
311  
Error message  
Description  
The battery is exhausted. Install a fully charged  
battery in the camera. (p.49)  
Battery depleted  
Appears during sensor cleaning if the battery  
level is insufficient. Install a fully charged  
battery or use an AC adapter kit (optional).  
Not enough battery  
power remaining to  
clean sensor  
Appears during pixel mapping if the battery  
level is insufficient. Install a fully charged  
battery or use an AC adapter kit (optional).  
Not enough battery  
power remaining to  
activate Pixel Mapping  
The maximum folder number (999) and file  
number (9999) are being used, and no more  
images can be saved. Insert a new SD Memory  
Card or format the card. (p.246)  
Image folder cannot be  
created  
The image could not be saved because of an  
SD Memory Card error.  
Unable to store image  
Settings not stored  
The DPOF settings could not be saved because  
the SD Memory Card is full. Delete unwanted  
images and perform DPOF setting again. (p.74)  
The camera was unable to measure the manual  
white balance (p.185) or detect dust on the  
sensor (p.301). Try the operation again.  
The operation could not be  
completed correctly  
You cannot select more than the maximum  
number of images for Index (p.215), Select &  
Delete (p.220), Developing Multiple RAW  
Images (p.240) and DPOF (p.271).  
No more images can be  
selected  
There are no images that can be processed  
No image can be processed using Digital Filter (p.233) or RAW  
Development (p.238).  
Appears when you try to perform Save as  
Manual WB (p.187), Resize (p.230), Cropping  
(p.231), Digital Filter (p.233), or RAW  
This image cannot be  
Development (p.238) for images captured with  
processed  
other cameras, or when you try to perform  
11  
Resize or Cropping for minimum file size  
images.  
The camera failed to create  
an image  
The creation of an index print image failed.  
(p.215)  
Live View cannot be used because the  
camera’s internal temperature is too high.  
Press the 4 button and try using Live View  
again when the camera has cooled down.  
Camera overheated.  
Disabling Live View temporarily  
to protect circuitry  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
312  
Error message  
Description  
Appears if Live View is started when [27. Using  
Aperture Ring] is set to [Prohibited] in the [A  
Custom Setting 4] menu and the lens aperture  
ring is set to a position other than s, or a lens  
without an s position is being used.  
Cannot start Live View  
You are trying to set a function that is not  
available when the exposure mode is set to B  
(Green) or C (Movie).  
This function is not available  
in the current mode  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
313  
Troubleshooting  
In rare cases, the camera may not operate correctly due to static  
electricity. This can be remedied by taking the battery out and putting it  
back in again. When the mirror remains in the up position, take the battery  
out and put it back in again. Then, the mirror will retract when the camera  
is turned on again. After these procedures are done, if the camera  
operates correctly, it does not require any repairs.  
We recommend checking the following items before contacting a service  
center.  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
The battery is not Check if a battery is installed. If not, install a  
The camera  
does not turn  
on  
installed fully charged battery.  
The battery power Replace with a fully charged battery or use  
is low  
the AC adapter kit (optional). (p.52)  
Set the lens aperture ring to the s position  
or select [Permitted] in [27. Using Aperture  
Ring] of the [A Custom Setting 4] menu.  
The lens aperture  
ring is set to other  
than the s position  
The shutter  
cannot be  
released  
The built-in flash is  
charging  
Wait until charging is finished.  
Thereisnoavailable Insert an SD Memory Card with available  
space on the SD  
Memory Card  
space or delete unwanted images. (p.54,  
p.74)  
Recording  
Wait until recording is finished.  
Autofocus cannot focus well on subjects  
that have low contrast (the sky, white walls,  
etc.), dark colors, intricate designs, rapidly-  
moving objects or scenery shot through a  
window or a net-like pattern. Lock focus on  
another object located at the same distance  
as your subject, then aim at the target and  
press the shutter release button fully.  
The subject is  
difficult to focus on  
11  
Autofocus  
does not work  
Alternatively, use manual focus. (p.116)  
Position the subject in the focus frame in the  
The subject is not middle of the viewfinder. If the subject is outside  
in the focusing  
area  
the focusing area, aim the camera at the subject  
and lock the focus, then compose a picture and  
press the shutter release button fully.  
The subject is too Move away from the subject and take a  
close picture.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
314  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
Autofocus  
The focus mode is Set the focus mode switch to l or A.  
does not work set to \  
(p.108)  
Autofocus is not locked (focus lock) when  
the focus mode is set to k (A). The  
camera will continue focusing on the subject  
while the shutter release button is pressed  
halfway. If there is a subject that you wish to  
focus on, slide the focus mode switch to  
l and use the focus lock. (p.108)  
The focus  
cannot be  
locked  
The focus mode is  
set to k  
The AE Lock  
Set the exposure mode to any mode other  
The exposure  
function does mode is set to B, than B (Green), p (Bulb Exposure) or M  
not operate  
p or M mode  
(Flash X-sync Speed).  
Only C (Auto Flash Discharge) and D  
(Auto Flash+Red-eye Reduction) are  
available for the flash mode when the  
exposure mode is B (Green). The flash will  
The built-in  
The exposure  
flash does not mode is set to B not discharge when the subject is bright in  
discharge  
mode  
these modes. In the exposure modes other  
than B, only the flash mode that  
discharges every time the flash recharges is  
available. Try different exposure modes.  
The USB  
connectionwith The USB  
Set [USB Connection] to [MSC] in the [R  
Set-up 2] menu. (p.279)  
a computer  
connectionmodeis  
does not work set to [PTP]  
properly  
The Shake  
Reduction function  
is off  
Set [Shake Reduction] to k (On) in the  
[A Rec. Mode 4] menu. (p.122)  
If a lens for which the focal length  
information cannot be obtained is used, set  
the focal length in the [Input Focal Length]  
screen. (p.124)  
The Shake  
Reduction function  
is not set properly  
Shake  
Reduction  
does not work  
Shutter speedis too  
low for the Shake  
11  
Reduction function Turn off the Shake Reduction function and  
to be effective when use a tripod.  
panningor shooting  
night scenes, etc.  
The subject is too Move away from the subject, or turn off the  
close  
Shake Reduction function and use a tripod.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
315  
Main Specifications  
Model Description  
TTL autofocus, auto-exposure SLR digital-still camera with  
built-in retractable P-TTL flash  
Type  
PENTAX KAF2 bayonet mount (AF coupler, lens information  
contacts, K-mount with power contacts)  
Lens Mount  
Compatible Lens  
KAF3, KAF2 (power zoom compatible), KAF, KA mount lenses  
Image Capture Unit  
Image Sensor  
Effective Pixels  
Total Pixels  
Primary color filter, CMOS, Size: 23.7 x 15.7 (mm)  
Approx. 16.28 megapixels  
Approx. 16.93 megapixels  
Image sensor cleaning using ultrasonic vibrations “DR II” with  
the Dust Alert function  
Dust Removal  
Sensitivity (Standard AUTO: 100 to 12800 (EV steps can be set to 1 EV, 1/2 EV or 1/3  
Output)  
EV), expandable to ISO 80 - 51200.  
Image Stabilizer  
Sensor-shift Shake Reduction  
File Formats  
File Formats  
RAW (PEF/DNG), JPEG (Exif 2.30), DCF 2.0 compliant  
JPEG: p (4928×3264 pixels), J (3936×2624 pixels),  
P (3072×2048 pixels), i (1728×1152 pixels)  
RAW: p (4928×3264 pixels)  
Recorded Pixels  
Quality Level  
RAW (14bit): PEF, DNG JPEG: Z (Premium), C  
(Best), D (Better), E (Good), RAW + JPEG simultaneous  
capturing compatible  
Color Space  
sRGB, AdobeRGB  
Storage Medium  
SD, SDHC, and SDXC Memory Cards  
Date (100_1018,101_1019...)/  
PENTX (100PENTX, 101PENTX...)  
Storage Folder  
Viewfinder  
Type  
11  
Pentaprism Finder  
Coverage (FOV)  
Magnification  
Approx. 100%  
Approx. 0.92× (50 mm F1.4 • )  
Approx. 21.7 mm (from the view window), Approx. 24.5 mm  
(from the center of lens)  
Eye-Relief Length  
-1  
Diopter Adjustment  
Focusing Screen  
Approx. -2.5 to +1.5m  
Interchangeable Natural-Bright-Matte III focusing screen  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
316  
Live View  
Type  
TTL method using CMOS image sensor  
Contrast detection + Face detection, Contrast detection, Phase  
matching  
Focusing Mechanism  
Field of View approx. 100%, Magnified view (  
mode: 2 , 4 , 6 , 8 , 10 ), Grid display (4  
Section, Scale display), Bright/dark area warning, Histogram  
=
mode: 2  
×, 4×,  
Display  
6
×
/
\
×
×
×
×
×
×
4 Grid, Golden  
LCD Monitor  
Wide viewing angle TFT color LCD with AR coating and air  
gapless glass  
Type  
Size  
3.0 inches  
Dots  
Approx. 921,000 dots  
Brightness and colors adjustable  
Adjustment  
Preview  
Type  
Optical preview, digital preview  
White Balance  
Method using a combination of the CMOS sensor and the light-  
source detection sensor  
Auto  
Daylight, Shade, Cloudy, Fluorescent Light (D: Daylight Color,  
N: Daylight White, W: Cool White, L: Warm White), Tungsten  
Light, Flash, f, Manual, Color Temperature  
Preset  
Configuration using the display screen (up to 3 settings can be  
saved), Color Temperature settings (up to 3 settings can be  
saved), Copying the white balance settings of a captured image  
Manual  
Fine Adjustment  
Adjustable ±7 steps on A-B axis and/or G-M axis  
Autofocus System  
Type  
TTL: phase-matching autofocus  
Focus Sensor  
Brightness Range  
SAFOX X, 11 points (9 cross type focus points in the center)  
EV -3 to 18 (ISO100, at normal temperature)  
Single AF (l), Continuous AF (k)  
Focus priority or shutter priority mode for l  
Focus priority or FPS priority mode for k  
AF Mode  
11  
AF Point Selection  
AF Assist Light  
Auto: 5 points, Auto: 11 points, Select (Expanded Area AF is available), Center  
Dedicated LED AF assist light  
Exposure Control  
Type  
TTL open aperture, 77 segmented metering, center-weighted and spot metering  
Metering Range  
EV 0 to 22 (ISO100 50mm F1.4)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
317  
Green, Program, Sensitivity Priority, Shutter Priority, Aperture Priority,  
Shutter & Aperture Priority, Manual, Bulb, Flash X-sync Speed  
Exposure Mode  
EV Compensation  
±5 EV (1/2 EV steps or 1/3 EV steps can be selected)  
Available via dedicated AE Lock button (timer type: two times  
the meter operating time set in Custom Setting); Continuous as  
long as the shutter button is halfway pressed.  
AE Lock  
Shutter  
Type  
Electronically controlled vertical-run focal-plane shutter  
Auto: 1/8000 to 30 sec., Manual: 1/8000 to 30 sec. (1/3 EV  
steps or 1/ 2EV steps), Bulb  
Shutter Speed  
Drive Modes  
Single frame, Continuous (Hi, Lo), Self-timer (12s, 2s), Remote  
Control (immediately, 3 sec., continuous), Auto Bracketing (2, 3 or  
5 frames), Auto Bracketing + Self-timer, Auto Bracketing +  
Remote Control, Mirror Lock-up, Mirror Lock-up + Remote Control  
Mode Selection  
Max. approx. 7.0 fps, JPEG (pC•Continuous Hi): up to  
approx. 30 frames, RAW: up to approx. 20 frames  
Max. approx. 1.6 fps, JPEG (pC•Continuous Lo): until  
SD Memory Card is full, RAW: up to approx. 40 frames  
Continuous Shooting  
Flash  
Built-in retractable P-TTL pop-up flash, GN: approx. 13 (ISO100/m)  
Angle of view: equivalent to angle of view of 28mm lens (35mm format equivalent)  
Built-in Flash  
P-TTL, Red-eye Reduction, Slow-speed Sync, Trailing Curtain  
Sync; High-Speed Sync and Wireless Sync are available with  
PENTAX dedicated external flash.  
Flash Mode  
Sync Speed  
1/180 sec.  
Flash Exposure  
Compensation  
-2.0 to +1.0 EV  
Capture Functions  
Custom Image  
Bright, Natural, Portrait, Landscape, Vibrant, Muted, Bleach  
Bypass, Reversal Film, Monochrome  
Noise Reduction  
Slow Shutter Speed NR, High-ISO NR  
11  
Dynamic Range Setting Highlight Correction, Shadow Correction  
Lens Correction  
Distortion Correction, Lateral Chromatic Aberration Correction  
Cross Processing  
Random, Preset 1-3, Favorite 1-3  
Toy Camera, Retro, High Contrast, Extract Color, Soft,  
Starburst, Fish-eye, Custom Filter  
Digital Filter  
Auto, Standard, Strong 1, Strong 2, Strong 3  
Auto Align (automatic composition correction)  
HDR Capture  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
318  
Select the number of shots between 2 and 9.  
Exposure adjusted automatically. (Auto EV Adjustment)  
Multi-exposure  
Capture Interval setting (1 sec. to 24 hr.), Start Interval setting  
(immediate, designated time), Captures up to 999 images  
Interval Shooting  
White Balance, Saturation, Hue, High/Low Key Adj, Contrast,  
Sharpness  
Extended Bracketing  
Horizon Correction  
SR On: adjusts up to 1 degree, SR Off: adjusts up to 2 degrees  
Composition  
Adjustment  
Adjustment range of ±1.5 mm up, down, left or right (±1 mm  
when rotated); rotating range of ±1 degree  
Displayed on LCD panel or in viewfinder (horizontal direction only);  
displayed on monitor (horizontal direction and vertical direction)  
Electronic Level  
Movie  
File Format  
Motion JPEG (AVI)  
a (1920×1080, 16:9, 25 fps), b (1280×720, 16:9, 30 fps/  
25 fps), c (640×480, 4:3, 30 fps/25 fps)  
Recorded Pixels  
Quality Level  
Sound  
C (Best), D (Better), E (Good)  
Built-in monaural microphone, external stereo microphone  
terminal  
Up to 25 minutes; automatically stops recording if the internal  
temperature of the camera becomes high.  
Recording Time  
Custom Image  
Bright, Natural, Portrait, Landscape, Vibrant, Muted, Bleach  
Bypass, Reversal Film, Monochrome  
Cross Processing  
Digital Filter  
Random, Preset 1-3, Favorite 1-3  
Toy Camera, Retro, High Contrast, Extract Color, Color  
Playback Functions  
Single frame, multi-image display (4, 9, 16, 36, 81  
segmentation), display magnification (up to 32x, scrolling and  
quick magnification available), rotating, histogram (Y  
histogram, RGB histogram), bright/dark area warning, auto  
image rotation, detailed information display, copyright  
information display (photographer, copyright holder), GPS data  
(latitude, longitude, altitude, direction, Coordinated Universal  
Time (UTC)), folder display, calendar display, slideshow  
Playback View  
Delete single image, delete all, select & delete, delete folder,  
delete instant review image  
11  
Delete  
Toy Camera, Retro, High Contrast, Sketch Filter, Water Color,  
Pastel, Posterization, Miniature, Base Parameter Adjustment,  
Monochrome, Color, Extract Color, Soft, Starburst, Fish-eye,  
Slim, HDR, Custom Filter  
Digital Filter  
File Format (JPEG, TIFF), Recorded Pixels, Quality Level,  
Custom Image, White Balance, Sensitivity, High-ISO NR,  
Shadow Correction, Distortion Correction, Lateral Chromatic  
Aberration Correction, Color Space  
RAW Development  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
319  
Resize, Cropping (aspect ratio can be changed, and tilt  
correction is available), Index, Movie Edit (Divide or delete  
selected frames), Capturing a JPEG still picture from a movie,  
Saving RAW data from JPEG (if available in buffer memory)  
Edit  
Customization  
User Mode  
Up to 5 settings can be saved.  
Custom Functions  
Mode Memory  
27 items  
13 items  
E-Dial Programming Electronic dials (front/rear): customizable to each exposure mode.  
|
/Y  
button (One Push File Format, Exposure Bracketing,  
Custom Button  
Digital Preview, Electronic Level, Composition Adjustment, GPS)  
= button (Enable AF, Cancel AF)  
Text Size  
Standard, Large  
World Time  
World Time settings for 75 cities (28 time zones)  
AF Fine Adjustment ±10 steps, adjustment for all lenses or individual lenses (up to 20 can be saved)  
Names of “Photographer” and “Copyright Holder” are  
Copyright Information embedded to the image file.  
Revision history can be checked using the provided software.  
Power Supply  
Battery Type  
AC Adapter  
Rechargeable Lithium-ion Battery D-LI90  
AC Adapter kit K-AC132 (optional)  
Number of recordable images (with 50% flash usage): approx.  
740 images,  
(without flash usage): approx. 980 images  
Playback time: approx. 440 minutes  
* Tested in compliance with CIPA standard using a new  
rechargeable lithium-ion battery under the temperature of  
23°C. Actual results may vary depending on the shooting  
conditions/circumstances.  
Battery Life  
Interfaces  
USB 2.0 (high-speed compatible)/AV output, DC input, Cable  
switch, X-sync socket, HDMI output, Stereo microphone  
Connection Port  
USB Connection  
MSC/PTP  
11  
Video Output Format NTSC/PAL  
Dimensions and Weight  
Approx. 131 mm (W) × 97 mm (H) × 72.5 mm (D) (excluding  
protrusions)  
Dimensions  
Weight  
Approx. 680 g (body only), Approx. 760 g (including dedicated  
battery and SD Memory Card)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
320  
Accessories  
Package Contents  
Software  
USB Cable I-USB7, AV Cable I-AVC7, Strap O-ST132, ME  
Viewfinder Cap, Rechargeable Lithium-ion Battery D-LI90,  
Battery Charger D-BC90, AC plug cord, Software (CD-ROM)  
S-SW132  
<Mounted on the camera> Eyecup FR, Hot shoe cover FK, Body  
mount cover, Sync socket 2P cap  
PENTAX Digital Camera Utility 4  
 Approximate Image Storage Capacity and Playback Time  
When using the fully charged battery  
Flash Photography  
Normal  
Recording  
Battery  
D-LI90  
Playback Time  
(Temperature)  
(23°C)  
50% Use  
740  
100% Use  
610  
980  
810  
440 minutes  
400 minutes  
( 0°C)  
680  
560  
The image storage capacity (normal recording and flash use 50%) is based on  
measuring conditions in accordance with CIPA standards, while other data is based  
on our measuring conditions. Some deviation from the above figures may occur in  
actual use depending on the selected capture mode and shooting conditions.  
 Approximate Image Storage Capacity by Size  
When using a 2 GB SD Memory Card  
JPEG Quality  
Recorded Pixels  
RAW  
Z
134  
C
214  
D
379  
E
(4928×3264)  
(3936×2624)  
(3072×2048)  
(1728×1152)  
749  
58  
p
J
P
i
208  
332  
585  
1138  
1807  
5121  
339  
543  
945  
1041  
1617  
2793  
The number of storable images may vary depending on the subject, shooting  
conditions, selected capture mode and SD Memory Card, etc.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
321  
Index  
Automatic sensitivity correction  
............................................... 84  
Symbols  
B
Base Parameter Adj (Digital  
Bleach Bypass (Custom Image)  
A
Aperture Priority Automatic  
11  
Exposure Mode c ................95  
C
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
322  
Contrast-Control-Sync mode  
(Flash) ..................................174  
Detailed information display  
............................................... 31  
Displaying multiple images  
............................................. 212  
E
Customizing buttons and dials  
.............................................247  
D
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
323  
F
H
Filter Effect (Custom Image)  
.............................................199  
High dynamic range shooting  
............................................. 191  
High/Low Key Adjustment  
Flash Exposure Compensation  
...............................................71  
.............................................102  
Fluorescent Light (White  
Balance) ...............................183  
(Custom Image) ................... 198  
High-Speed Flash Sync mode  
(Flash) .................................. 169  
I
11  
G
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
324  
Monochrome (Custom Image)  
............................................. 197  
Monochrome (Digital Filter)  
............................................. 233  
J
K
L
Landscape (Custom Image)  
.............................................197  
Lateral chromatic aberration  
.............................................193  
N
M
O
11  
P
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
325  
PENTAX Digital Camera  
Reversal Film (Custom Image)  
............................................. 197  
Utility 4 .................................281  
Playing back images  
continuously .........................217  
Posterization (Digital Filter)  
.............................................233  
Program Automatic Exposure  
mode e ..................................91  
S
Saturation (Custom Image)  
............................................. 198  
Sensitivity Priority Automatic  
Exposure mode K ............... 92  
Sharpness (Custom Image)  
............................................. 198  
Shutter & Aperture Priority  
Q
............................................... 97  
Shutter Priority Automatic  
11  
R
Exposure mode b ................ 94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
326  
W
X
Z
T
Tungsten Light (White Balance)  
.............................................183  
11  
U
V
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
327  
WARRANTY POLICY  
All PENTAX cameras purchased through authorized bona fide  
photographic distribution channels are guaranteed against defects of  
material or workmanship for a period of twelve months from date of  
purchase. Service will be rendered, and defective parts will be replaced  
without cost to you within that period, provided the equipment does not  
show evidence of impact, sand or liquid damage, mishandling, tampering,  
battery or chemical corrosion, operation contrary to operating instructions,  
or modification by an unauthorized repair shop. The manufacturer or its  
authorized representatives shall not be liable for any repair or alterations  
except those made with its written consent and shall not be liable for  
damages from delay or loss of use or from other indirect or consequential  
damages of any kind, whether caused by defective material or  
workmanship or otherwise; and it is expressly agreed that the liability of  
the manufacturer or its representatives under all guarantees or warranties,  
whether expressed or implied, is strictly limited to the replacement of parts  
as hereinbefore provided. No refunds will be made on repairs by non-  
authorized PENTAX service facilities.  
Procedure During 12-month Warranty Period  
Any PENTAX which proves defective during the 12-month warranty period  
should be returned to the dealer from whom you purchased the equipment  
or to the manufacturer. If there are no representatives of the manufacturer  
in your country, send the equipment to the manufacturer, with postage  
prepaid. In this case, it will take a considerable length of time before the  
equipment can be returned to you owing to the complicated customs  
procedures required. If the equipment is covered by warranty, repairs will  
be made and parts replaced free of charge, and the equipment will be  
returned to you upon completion of servicing. If the equipment is not  
covered by warranty, regular charges of the manufacturer or of its  
representatives will apply. Shipping charges are to be borne by the owner.  
If your PENTAX was purchased outside of the country where you wish to  
have it serviced during the warranty period, regular handling and servicing  
fees may be charged by the manufacturer’s representatives in that  
country. Notwithstanding this, your PENTAX returned to the manufacturer  
will be serviced free of charge according to this procedure and warranty  
policy. In any case, however, shipping charges and customs clearance  
fees to be borne by the sender. To prove the date of your purchase when  
required, please keep the receipt or bills covering the purchase of your  
equipment for at least a year. Before sending your equipment for servicing,  
please make sure that you are sending it to the manufacturer’s authorized  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
328  
representatives or their approved repair shops, unless you are sending it  
directly to the manufacturer. Always obtain a quotation for the service  
charge, and only after you accept the quoted service charge, instruct the  
service station to proceed with the servicing.  
• This warranty policy does not affect the customer’s statutory  
rights.  
• The local warranty policies available from PENTAX distributors in  
some countries can supersede this warranty policy. Therefore, we  
recommend that you review the warranty card supplied with your  
product at the time of purchase, or contact the PENTAX distributor  
in your country for more information and to receive a copy of the  
warranty policy.  
11  
The CE Mark is a Directive conformity mark of the European  
Union.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
329  
For customers in USA  
STATEMENT OF FCC COMPLIANCE  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject  
to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not approved by the party responsible for  
compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a  
Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against  
harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment  
generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not  
installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular installation.  
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television  
reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,  
the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of  
the following measures:  
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to  
which the receiver is connected.  
* Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
For customers in Canada  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Pour les utilisateurs au Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003  
du Canada.  
11  
FOR CALIFORNIA, U.S.A. ONLY  
Perchlorate Material-special handling may apply.  
The lithium battery used in this camera contains perchlorate material,  
which may require special handling.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
330  
Declaration of Conformity  
According to 47CFR, Parts 2 and 15 for  
Class B Personal Computers and Peripherals  
We:  
PENTAX RICOH IMAGING AMERICAS  
CORPORATION  
th  
Located at:  
633 17 Street, Suite 2600  
Denver, Colorado 80202 U.S.A.  
Phone: 800-877-0155 FAX: 303-790-1131  
Declare under sole responsibility that the product identified herein  
complies with 47CFR Parts 2 and 15 of the FCC rules as a Class B digital  
device. Each product marketed is identical to the representative unit tested  
and found to be compliant with the standards. Records maintained  
continue to reflect the equipment being produced can be expected to be  
within the variation accepted, due to quantity production and testing on the  
statistical basis as required by 47CFR §2.909. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation. The above  
named party is responsible for ensuring that the equipment complies with  
the standards of 47CFR §15.101 to §15.109.  
Product Name: Digital Single Lens Reflex Camera  
II  
Model Number: K-5 /K-5  
II  
s
Contact person: Customer Service Manager  
Date and Place: September, 2012, Colorado  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
331  
Information for Users on Collection and Disposal of Old  
Equipment and Used Batteries  
1. In the European Union  
These symbols on the products, packaging and/or  
accompanying documents mean that used electrical and  
electronic equipment and batteries should not be mixed with  
general household waste.  
Used electrical/electronic equipment and batteries must be  
treated separately and in accordance with legislation that  
requires proper treatment, recovery and recycling of these  
products.  
By disposing of these products correctly you will help ensure  
that the waste undergoes the necessary treatment, recovery  
and recycling and thus prevent potential negative effects on the  
environment and human health which could otherwise arise  
due to inappropriate waste handling.  
If a chemical symbol is added beneath the symbol shown above, in  
accordance with the Battery Directive, this indicates that a heavy metal  
(Hg = Mercury, Cd = Cadmium, Pb = Lead) is present in the battery at a  
concentration above an applicable threshold specified in the Battery  
Directive.  
For more information about collection and recycling of used products,  
please contact your local authorities, your waste disposal service or the  
point of sale where you purchased the products.  
2. In other countries outside the EU  
These symbols are only valid in the European Union. If you wish to discard  
used products, please contact your local authorities or dealer and ask for  
the correct method of disposal.  
For Switzerland: Used electrical/electronic equipment can be returned free  
of charge to the dealer, even when you don't purchase a new product.  
Further collection facilities are listed on the home page of www.swico.ch  
or www.sens.ch.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Pelco Work Light WS5000 User Manual
Philips Camera Accessories LR6PC20X User Manual
Philips Charcoal Grill CBC608A User Manual
Philips Clock Radio D3996 User Manual
Philips DVR HTR5204 User Manual
Philips Stereo System SWA3604W User Manual
Planet Technology TV Converter Box ICS 100 User Manual
Poulan Tiller PRRT9000 User Manual
PYLE Audio Car Stereo System PLDVD138 User Manual
PYLE Audio CD Player PICL48 User Manual